Cisco Systems Network Card 57712 User Manual

Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI  
Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
First Published: March 04, 2013  
Americas Headquarters  
Cisco Systems, Inc.  
170 West Tasman Drive  
San Jose, CA 95134-1706  
USA  
http://www.cisco.com  
Tel: 408 526-4000  
800 553-NETS (6387)  
Fax: 408 527-0883  
Text Part Number: OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
C H A P T E R 4  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
iv  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preface  
This preface includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
•
Audience  
This guide is intended primarily for data center administrators with responsibilities and expertise in one or  
more of the following:  
Server administration  
Storage administration  
Network administration  
Network security  
•
•
•
•
Conventions  
Text Type  
Indication  
GUI elements  
GUI elements such as tab titles, area names, and field labels appear in this font.  
Main titles such as window, dialog box, and wizard titles appear in this font.  
Document titles  
TUI elements  
System output  
Document titles appear in this font.  
In a Text-based User Interface, text the system displays appears in this font.  
Terminal sessions and information that the system displays appear in this  
font.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
xi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Preface  
Conventions  
Text Type  
Indication  
CLI commands  
CLI command keywords appear in this font.  
Variables in a CLI command appear in this font.  
[ ]  
Elements in square brackets are optional.  
{x | y | z}  
Required alternative keywords are grouped in braces and separated by vertical  
bars.  
[x | y | z]  
string  
Optional alternative keywords are grouped in brackets and separated by vertical  
bars.  
A nonquoted set of characters. Do not use quotation marks around the string or  
the string will include the quotation marks.  
< >  
[ ]  
Nonprinting characters such as passwords are in angle brackets.  
Default responses to system prompts are in square brackets.  
!, #  
An exclamation point (!) or a pound sign (#) at the beginning of a line of code  
indicates a comment line.  
Note  
Means reader take note. Notes contain helpful suggestions or references to material not covered in the  
document.  
Tip  
Means the following information will help you solve a problem. The tips information might not be  
troubleshooting or even an action, but could be useful information, similar to a Timesaver.  
Caution  
Means reader be careful. In this situation, you might perform an action that could result in equipment  
damage or loss of data.  
Timesaver  
Means the described action saves time. You can save time by performing the action described in the  
paragraph.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
xii  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preface  
New and Changed Information for this Release  
Warning  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS  
This warning symbol means danger. You are in a situation that could cause bodily injury. Before you  
work on any equipment, be aware of the hazards involved with electrical circuitry and be familiar with  
standard practices for preventing accidents. Use the statement number provided at the end of each warning  
to locate its translation in the translated safety warnings that accompanied this device.  
SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS  
New and Changed Information for this Release  
The following tables provide an overview of the significant changes to this guide for the current release. The  
tables do not provide an exhaustive list of all changes made to the configuration guides or of the new features  
in this release.  
For a complete list of all C-Series documentation, see the Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Documentation Roadmap  
available at the following URL: http://www.cisco.com/go/unifiedcomputing/c-series-doc .  
New Features and Significant Behavioral Changes in Cisco Integrated Management Controller software,  
Release 1.4(6)  
Feature  
Description  
Where Documented  
Cisco UCS VIC1225 Virtual  
Interface Card  
Support added for the Cisco UCS  
VIC1225 Virtual Interface Card.  
on page 83  
BIOS Properties  
Support for additional BIOS properties BIOS Parameters by Server  
for the Cisco UCS C22 M3 Server,  
Cisco UCS C24 M3 Server, Cisco UCS  
C220 M3 Server, and the Cisco UCS  
C240 M3 Server.  
Model, on page 183  
New Features and Significant Behavioral Changes in Cisco Integrated Management Controller software,  
Release 1.4(5)  
Feature  
Description  
Where Documented  
Hard Disk Drive LED  
Support added for toggling the LED on Managing the Server, on page  
an installed hard disk drive. 13  
BIOS Properties  
Support for additional BIOS properties BIOS Parameters by Server  
for the Cisco UCS C220 M3 Server and Model, on page 183  
the Cisco UCS C240 M3 Server.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
xiii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Preface  
New and Changed Information for this Release  
New Features and Significant Behavioral Changes in Cisco Integrated Management Controller software,  
Release 1.4(4)  
Feature  
Description  
Where Documented  
Platform support  
The features available in Release 1.4(3) Release Notes for Cisco UCS  
are now available on the Cisco UCS C-Series Software, Release  
C220 M3 Server and the Cisco UCS 1.4(4)  
C240 M3 Server.  
BIOS Properties  
Support for additional BIOS properties BIOS Parameters by Server  
for the Cisco UCS C220 M3 Server and Model, on page 183  
the Cisco UCS C240 M3 Server.  
New Features and Significant Behavioral Changes in Cisco Integrated Management Controller software,  
Release 1.4(3)  
Feature  
Description  
Where Documented  
Integration with Cisco UCS  
Manager  
The supported servers can be integrated See the Hardware Installation  
into a Cisco UCS domain.  
Guide (HIG) for the type of  
server you are using. The  
C-Series HIGs are available at  
the following URL: http://  
Technical support  
BIOS parameters  
Support added for downloading the  
tech support information file from a  
browser.  
Server Utilities, on page 173  
Support added for additional BIOS  
properties.  
Model, on page 183  
New Features and Significant Behavioral Changes in Cisco Integrated Management Controller software,  
Release 1.4(2)  
Feature  
Description  
Where Documented  
Platform support  
The features available in Release 1.4(1) Release Notes for Cisco UCS  
are now available on the Cisco UCS C-Series Software, Release  
C460 M2 Server and the Cisco UCS 1.4(2)  
C260 M2 Server.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
xiv  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preface  
Related Cisco UCS Documentation  
Feature  
Description  
Where Documented  
BIOS parameters  
Support added for additional BIOS  
properties.  
Model, on page 183  
New Features and Significant Behavioral Changes in Cisco Integrated Management Controller software,  
Release 1.4(1)  
Feature  
Description  
Where Documented  
Platform support  
The features in this release apply to the Release Notes for Cisco UCS  
Cisco UCS C200 M1 Server, the Cisco C-Series Software, Release  
UCS C210 M1 Server, and the Cisco 1.4(1)  
UCS C250 M1 Server.  
VM FEX  
Support is added for virtual machine Managing Network Adapters,  
fabric extenders (VM FEX).  
on page 83  
Create vHBAs  
Support added in the CLI to create up Managing Network Adapters,  
to 16 vHBAs.  
on page 83  
Active Directory groups  
Enhanced SNMP features  
Support added for Active Directory  
authorization groups.  
page 65  
Enhanced SNMPv3 and SNMP trap  
configuration is relocated in the user Services, on page 133  
interface.  
XML API  
Support added for CIMC control by an Configuring Communication  
XML API.  
Services, on page 133  
HTTP redirect  
BIOS parameters  
Support added for redirection of HTTP Configuring Communication  
requests to HTTPS.  
Services, on page 133  
Support added for additional BIOS  
properties.  
Model, on page 183  
Related Cisco UCS Documentation  
Documentation Roadmaps  
For a complete list of all B-Series documentation, see the Cisco UCS B-Series Servers Documentation Roadmap  
available at the following URL: http://www.cisco.com/go/unifiedcomputing/b-series-doc.  
For a complete list of all C-Series documentation, see the Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Documentation Roadmap  
available at the following URL: http://www.cisco.com/go/unifiedcomputing/c-series-doc .  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
xv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Preface  
Related Cisco UCS Documentation  
Other Documentation Resources  
An ISO file containing all B and C-Series documents is available at the following URL: http://www.cisco.com/  
cisco/software/type.html?mdfid=283853163&flowid=25821. From this page, click Unified Computing  
System (UCS) Documentation Roadmap Bundle.  
The ISO file is updated after every major documentation release.  
Follow Cisco UCS Docs on Twitter to receive document update notifications.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
xvi  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
C H A P T E R  
1
Overview  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
•
Overview of the Cisco UCS C-Series Rack-Mount Servers  
The Cisco UCS C-Series rack-mount servers include the following models:  
Cisco UCS C200 Rack-Mount Server  
Cisco UCS C210 Rack-Mount Server  
Cisco UCS C220 Rack-Mount Server  
Cisco UCS C240 Rack-Mount Server  
Cisco UCS C250 Rack-Mount Server  
Cisco UCS C260 Rack-Mount Server  
Cisco UCS C460 Rack-Mount Server  
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Note  
To determine which Cisco UCS C-Series rack-mount servers are supported by this firmware release, see  
the associated Release Notes. The C-Series release notes are available at the following URL: http://  
Overview of the Server Software  
The Cisco UCS C-Series Rack-Mount Server ships with two major software systems installed.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Overview  
Cisco Integrated Management Controller  
CIMC Firmware  
CIMC is a separate management module built into the motherboard. A dedicated ARM-based processor,  
separate from the main server CPU, runs the CIMC firmware. The system ships with a running version of the  
CIMC firmware. You can update the CIMC firmware, but no initial installation is needed.  
Server OS  
The main server CPU runs an OS such as Windows or Linux. The server ships with a pre-installed OS, but  
you can install a different OS using the DVD drive or over the network. You can use CIMC to install the new  
OS using the KVM console and vMedia.  
Note  
You can access the available OS installation documentation from the Cisco UCS C-Series Servers  
Cisco Integrated Management Controller  
The CIMC is the management service for the C-Series servers. CIMC runs within the server.  
Note  
The CIMC management service is used only when the server is operating in Standalone Mode. If your  
C-Series server is integrated into a UCS system, you must manage it using UCS Manager. For information  
about using UCS Manager, see the configuration guides listed in the Cisco UCS B-Series Servers  
Management Interfaces  
You can use a web-based GUI or SSH-based CLI to access, configure, administer, and monitor the server.  
Almost all tasks can be performed in either interface, and the results of tasks performed in one interface are  
displayed in another. However, you cannot do the following:  
Use CIMC GUI to invoke CIMC CLI  
•
•
•
View a command that has been invoked through CIMC CLI in CIMC GUI  
Generate CIMC CLI output from CIMC GUI  
Tasks You Can Perform in CIMC  
You can use CIMC to perform the following server management tasks:  
Power on, power off, power cycle, reset and shut down the server  
Toggle the locator LED  
•
•
•
•
•
Configure the server boot order  
View server properties and sensors  
Manage remote presence  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
2
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Overview  
CIMC CLI  
Create and manage local user accounts, and enable remote user authentication through Active Directory  
Configure network-related settings, including NIC properties, IPv4, VLANs, and network security  
Configure communication services, including HTTP, SSH, and IPMI Over LAN  
Manage certificates  
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Configure platform event filters  
Update CIMC firmware  
Monitor faults, alarms, and server status  
No Operating System or Application Provisioning or Management  
CIMC provisions servers, and as a result, exists below the operating system on a server. Therefore, you cannot  
use it to provision or manage operating systems or applications on servers. For example, you cannot do the  
following:  
Deploy an OS, such as Windows or Linux  
•
•
•
•
•
Deploy patches for software, such as an OS or an application  
Install base software components, such as anti-virus software, monitoring agents, or backup clients  
Install software applications, such as databases, application server software, or web servers  
Perform operator actions, including restarting an Oracle database, restarting printer queues, or handling  
non-CIMC user accounts  
Configure or manage external storage on the SAN or NAS storage  
•
CIMC CLI  
The CIMC CLI is a command-line management interface for Cisco UCS C-Series servers. You can launch  
the CIMC CLI and manage the server over the network by SSH or Telnet. By default, Telnet access is disabled.  
A user of the CLI will be one of three roles: admin, user (can control, cannot configure), and read-only.  
Note  
To recover from a lost admin password, see the Cisco UCS C-Series server installation and service guide  
for your platform.  
Command Modes  
The CLI is organized into a hierarchy of command modes, with the EXEC mode being the highest-level mode  
of the hierarchy. Higher-level modes branch into lower-level modes. You use the scope command to move  
from higher-level modes to modes in the next lower level , and the exit command to move up one level in the  
mode hierarchy. The top command returns to the EXEC mode.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Overview  
Command Modes  
Note  
Most command modes are associated with managed objects. The scope command does not create managed  
objects and can only access modes for which managed objects already exist.  
Each mode contains a set of commands that can be entered in that mode. Most of the commands available in  
each mode pertain to the associated managed object. Depending on your assigned role, you may have access  
to only a subset of the commands available in a mode; commands to which you do not have access are hidden.  
The CLI prompt for each mode shows the full path down the mode hierarchy to the current mode. This helps  
you to determine where you are in the command mode hierarchy and can be an invaluable tool when you need  
to navigate through the hierarchy.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
4
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Overview  
Command Modes  
Command Mode Table  
The following table lists the first four levels of command modes, the commands used to access each mode,  
and the CLI prompt associated with each mode.  
Mode Name  
Command to Access  
Mode Prompt  
EXEC  
top command from any mode  
#
bios  
scope bios command from EXEC /bios #  
mode  
advanced  
main  
scope advanced command from /bios/advanced #  
bios mode  
scope main command from bios /bios/main #  
mode  
server-management  
scope server-management  
/bios/server-management #  
command from bios mode  
certificate  
chassis  
scope certificate command from /certificate #  
EXEC mode  
scope chassis command from  
/chassis #  
EXEC mode  
adapter  
scope adapter index command  
/chassis/adapter #  
from chassis mode  
host-eth-if  
scope host-eth-if command from /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if #  
adapter mode  
host-fc-if  
port-profiles  
vmfex  
scope host-fc-if command from  
adapter mode  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if #  
scope port-profiles command from /chassis/adapter/port-profiles #  
adapter mode  
scope vmfex index command from /chassis/adapter/vmfex #  
adapter mode  
dimm-summary  
flexflash  
scope dimm-summary index  
command from chassis mode  
/chassis/dimm-summary #  
/chassis/flexflash #  
scope flexflash index command  
from chassis mode  
operational-profiles  
scope operational-profile  
command from flexflash mode  
/chassis/flexflash/operational-profile  
#
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Overview  
Command Modes  
Mode Name  
Command to Access  
Mode Prompt  
storageadapter  
scope storageadapter slot  
/chassis/storageadapter #  
command from chassis mode  
physical-drive  
virtual-drive  
scope physical-drive command  
from storageadapter mode  
/chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive  
#
scope virtual-drive command  
from storageadapter mode  
/chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive  
#
cimc  
scope cimc command from EXEC /cimc #  
mode  
firmware  
import-export  
log  
scope firmware command from /cimc/firmware #  
cimc mode  
scope import-export command  
from cimc mode  
/cimc/import-export #  
/cimc/log #  
scope log command from cimc  
mode  
server  
scope server index command from /cimc/log/server #  
log mode  
network  
scope network command from  
/cimc/network #  
cimc mode  
ipblocking  
tech-support  
scope ipblocking command from /cimc/network/ipblocking #  
network mode  
scope tech-support command  
/cimc/tech-support #  
from cimc mode  
fault  
scope fault command from EXEC /fault #  
mode  
pef  
scope pef command from fault  
/fault/pef #  
mode  
http  
scope http command from EXEC /http #  
mode  
ipmi  
kvm  
scope ipmi command from EXEC /ipmi #  
mode  
scope kvm command from EXEC /kvm #  
mode  
ldap  
/ldap #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
6
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Overview  
Command Modes  
Mode Name  
Command to Access  
Mode Prompt  
scope ldap command from EXEC  
mode  
role-group  
scope role-group command from /ldap/role-group #  
ldap mode  
power-cap  
sel  
scope power-cap command from /power-cap #  
EXEC mode  
scope sel command from EXEC /sel #  
mode  
sensor  
scope sensor command from  
/sensor #  
EXEC mode  
snmp  
scope snmp command from EXEC /snmp #  
mode  
trap-destinations  
v3users  
sol  
scope trap-destinations command /snmp/trap-destinations #  
from snmp mode  
scope v3users command from  
/snmp/v3users #  
snmp mode  
scope sol command from EXEC /sol #  
mode  
ssh  
scope ssh command from EXEC /ssh #  
mode  
user  
scope user user-number command /user #  
from EXEC mode  
user-session  
vmedia  
scope user-session session-number /user-session #  
command from EXEC mode  
scope vmedia command from  
EXEC mode  
/vmedia #  
/xmlapi #  
xmlapi  
scope xmlapi command from  
EXEC mode  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Overview  
Complete a Command  
Complete a Command  
You can use the Tab key in any mode to complete a command. Partially typing a command name and pressing  
Tab causes the command to be displayed in full or to the point where another keyword must be chosen or an  
argument value must be entered.  
Command History  
The CLI stores all commands used in the current session. You can step through the previously used commands  
by using the Up Arrow or Down Arrow keys. The Up Arrow key steps to the previous command in the history,  
and the Down Arrow key steps to the next command in the history. If you get to the end of the history, pressing  
the Down Arrow key does nothing.  
All commands in the history can be entered again by simply stepping through the history to recall the desired  
command and pressing Enter. The command is entered as if you had manually typed it. You can also recall  
a command and change it before you press Enter.  
Committing, Discarding, and Viewing Pending Commands  
When you enter a configuration command in the CLI, the command is not applied until you enter the commit  
command. Until committed, a configuration command is pending and can be discarded by entering a discard  
command. When any command is pending, an asterisk (*) appears before the command prompt. The asterisk  
disappears when you enter the commit command, as shown in this example:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # set locator-led off  
Server /chassis *# commit  
Server /chassis #  
You can accumulate pending changes in multiple command modes and apply them together with a single  
commit command. You can view the pending commands by entering the show configuration pending  
command in any command mode.  
Note  
Committing multiple commands together is not an atomic operation. If any command fails, the successful  
commands are applied despite the failure. Failed commands are reported in an error message.  
Command Output Formats  
Most CLI show commands accept an optional detail keyword that causes the output information to be displayed  
as a list rather than a table. You can configure either of two presentation formats for displaying the output  
information when the detail keyword is used. The format choices are as follows:  
• Default—For easy viewing, the command output is presented in a compact list.  
This example shows command output in the default format:  
Server /chassis # set cli output default  
Server /chassis # show hdd detail  
Name HDD_01_STATUS:  
Status : present  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
8
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Overview  
Online Help for the CLI  
Name HDD_02_STATUS:  
Status : present  
Name HDD_03_STATUS:  
Status : present  
Name HDD_04_STATUS:  
Status : present  
Server /chassis #  
• YAML—For easy parsing by scripts, the command output is presented in the YAML (YAML Ain't  
Markup Language) data serialization language, delimited by defined character strings.  
This example shows command output in the YAML format:  
Server /chassis # set cli output yaml  
Server /chassis # show hdd detail  
---  
name: HDD_01_STATUS  
hdd-status: present  
---  
name: HDD_02_STATUS  
hdd-status: present  
---  
name: HDD_03_STATUS  
hdd-status: present  
---  
name: HDD_04_STATUS  
hdd-status: present  
...  
Server /chassis #  
For detailed information about YAML, see http://www.yaml.org/about.html.  
In most CLI command modes, you can enter set cli output default to configure the default format, or set cli  
output yaml to configure the YAML format.  
Online Help for the CLI  
At any time, you can type the ? character to display the options available at the current state of the command  
syntax.  
If you have not typed anything at the prompt, typing ? lists all available commands for the mode you are in.  
If you have partially typed a command, typing ? lists all available keywords and arguments available at your  
current position in the command syntax.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Overview  
Online Help for the CLI  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
OL-28893-01  
C H A P T E R  
2
Installing the Server OS  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
OS Installation Methods  
C-Series servers support several operating systems. Regardless of the OS being installed, you can install it  
on your server using one of the following tools:  
KVM console  
•
•
PXE installation server  
KVM Console  
The KVM console is an interface accessible from CIMC that emulates a direct keyboard, video, and mouse  
(KVM) connection to the server. The KVM console allows you to connect to the server from a remote location.  
Instead of using CD/DVD or floppy drives physically connected to the server, the KVM console uses virtual  
media, which are actual disk drives or disk image files that are mapped to virtual CD/DVD or floppy drives.  
You can map any of the following to a virtual drive:  
CD/DVD or floppy drive on your computer  
Disk image files (ISO or IMG files) on your computer  
USB flash drive on your computer  
•
•
•
•
•
•
CD/DVD or floppy drive on the network  
Disk image files (ISO or IMG files) on the network  
USB flash drive on the network  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Installing the Server OS  
PXE Installation Servers  
You can use the KVM console to install an OS on the server.  
PXE Installation Servers  
A Preboot Execution Environment (PXE) installation server allows a client to boot and install an OS from a  
remote location. To use this method, a PXE environment must be configured and available on your VLAN,  
typically a dedicated provisioning VLAN. Additionally, the server must be set to boot from the network.  
When the server boots, it sends a PXE request across the network. The PXE installation server acknowledges  
the request, and starts a sequence of events that installs the OS on the server.  
PXE servers can use installation disks, disk images, or scripts to install an OS. Proprietary disk images can  
also be used to install an OS, additional components, or applications.  
Note  
PXE installation is an efficient method for installing an OS on a large number of servers. However,  
considering that this method requires setting up a PXE environment, it might be easier to use another  
installation method.  
Installing an OS Using a PXE Installation Server  
Before You Begin  
Verify that the server can be reached over a VLAN.  
•
•
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to install an OS.  
Procedure  
Step 1 Set the boot order to PXE first.  
Step 2 Reboot the server.  
If a PXE install server is available on the VLAN, the installation process begins when the server reboots. PXE  
installations are typically automated and require no additional user input. Refer to the installation guide for  
the OS being installed to guide you through the rest of the installation process.  
What to Do Next  
After the OS installation is complete, reset the LAN boot order to its original setting.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
12  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
C H A P T E R  
3
Managing the Server  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Toggling the Locator LED  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with user or admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server # scope chassis  
Server /chassis # set locator-led {on | off} Enables or disables the chassis locator LED.  
Server /chassis # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system  
configuration.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OL-28893-01  
13  
       
This example disables the chassis locator LED and commits the transaction:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # set locator-led off  
Server /chassis *# commit  
Server /chassis #  
Toggling the Locator LED for a Hard Drive  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with user or admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server # scope chassis  
Enters chassis command mode.  
Server/chassis # scope hdd  
Enters hard disk drive (HDD) command mode.  
Where drivenum is the number of the hard  
         
Managing the Server  
Configuring the Server Boot Order  
Note  
The actual boot order will differ from the configured boot order if either of the following conditions occur:  
The BIOS encounters issues while trying to boot using the configured boot order.  
A user changes the boot order directly through the BIOS.  
•
•
Configuring the Server Boot Order  
Note  
Do not change the boot order while the host is performing BIOS power-on self test (POST).  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with user or admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope bios  
Enters bios command mode.  
Server /bios # set boot-order  
device1[,device2[,device3  
[,device4[,device5]]]]  
Specifies the boot device options and order. You can  
select one or more of the following:  
• cdrom—Bootable CD-ROM  
• fdd—Floppy disk drive  
• hdd—Hard disk drive  
• pxe—PXE boot  
• efi—Extensible Firmware Interface  
Step 3  
Server /bios # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
The new boot order will be used on the next BIOS boot.  
This example sets the boot order and commits the transaction:  
Server# scope bios  
Server /bios # set boot-order hdd,cdrom,fdd,pxe,efi  
Server /bios *# commit  
Server /bios # show detail  
BIOS:  
Boot Order: HDD,CDROM,FDD,PXE,EFI  
Server /bios #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing the Server  
Viewing the Actual Server Boot Order  
What to Do Next  
Reboot the server to boot with your new boot order.  
Viewing the Actual Server Boot Order  
The actual server boot order is the boot order actually used by the BIOS when the server last booted. The  
actual boot order can differ from the boot order configured in CIMC.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope bios  
Enters bios command mode.  
Server /bios # show actual-boot-order Displays the boot order actually used by the BIOS  
[detail]  
when the server last booted.  
This example displays the actual boot order from the last boot:  
Server# scope bios  
Server /bios # show actual-boot-order  
Boot Order  
Type  
Boot Device  
------------ ------------------------- -----------------------------------  
1
CD/DVD  
CD-ROM  
Cisco  
2
CD/DVD  
Virtual CD/DVD 1.18  
3
Network Device (PXE)  
Network Device (PXE)  
Network Device (PXE)  
Network Device (PXE)  
Network Device (PXE)  
Network Device (PXE)  
Internal EFI Shell  
FDD  
Cisco NIC 23:0.0  
4
MBA v5.0.5 Slot 0100  
MBA v5.0.5 Slot 0101  
MBA v5.0.5 Slot 0200  
MBA v5.0.5 Slot 0201  
Cisco NIC 22:0.0  
Internal EFI Shell  
Cisco  
Cisco  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
Virtual HDD  
1.18  
FDD  
Virtual Floppy 1.18  
Server /bios #  
Resetting the Server  
Important  
If any firmware or BIOS updates are in progress, do not reset the server until those tasks are complete.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with user or admin privileges to perform this task.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
16  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Managing the Server  
Shutting Down the Server  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # power hard-reset  
After a prompt to confirm, resets the server.  
This example resets the server:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # power hard-reset  
This operation will change the server's power state.  
Continue?[y|N]  
Shutting Down the Server  
Important  
If any firmware or BIOS updates are in progress, do not shut down the server until those tasks are complete.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with user or admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters chassis mode.  
Server /chassis # power shutdown  
Shuts down the server.  
The following example shuts down the server:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # power shutdown  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing the Server  
Managing Server Power  
Managing Server Power  
Powering On the Server  
Note  
If the server was powered off other than through the CIMC, the server will not become active immediately  
when powered on. In this case, the server will enter standby mode until the CIMC completes initialization.  
Important  
If any firmware or BIOS updates are in progress, do not change the server power until those tasks are  
complete.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with user or admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters chassis command mode.  
Turns on the server.  
Server /chassis # power on  
This example turns on the server:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # power on  
This operation will change the server's power state.  
Continue?[y|N]y  
Server /chassis # show  
Power Serial Number Product Name UUID  
----- ------------- ------------- ------------------------------------  
on  
Not Specified Not Specified 208F0100020F000000BEA80000DEAD00  
Powering Off the Server  
Important  
If any firmware or BIOS updates are in progress, do not power off the server until those tasks are complete.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with user or admin privileges to perform this task.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
18  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Managing the Server  
Power Cycling the Server  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters chassis command mode.  
Turns off the server.  
Server /chassis # power off  
This example turns off the server:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # power off  
This operation will change the server's power state.  
Continue?[y|N]y  
Server /chassis # show  
Power Serial Number Product Name UUID  
----- ------------- ------------- ------------------------------------  
off  
Not Specified Not Specified 208F0100020F000000BEA80000DEAD00  
Power Cycling the Server  
Important  
If any firmware or BIOS updates are in progress, do not power cycle the server until those tasks are  
complete.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with user or admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters chassis command mode.  
Power cycles the server.  
Server /chassis # power cycle  
This example power cycles the server:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # power cycle  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing the Server  
Configuring Power Policies  
Configuring Power Policies  
Viewing the Power Statistics  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Server# show power-cap [detail]  
Displays the server power consumption statistics  
and the power cap policy.  
The displayed fields are described in the following table:  
Name  
Description  
Current Consumption  
The power currently being used by the server, in watts.  
Maximum Consumption  
Minimum Consumption  
Minimum Configurable Limit  
The maximum number of watts consumed by the server since the last  
time it was rebooted.  
The minimum number of watts consumed by the server since the last  
time it was rebooted.  
The minimum amount of power that can be specified as the peak power  
cap for this server, in watts.  
Maximum Configurable Limit The maximum amount of power that can be specified as the peak power  
cap for this server, in watts.  
Additional fields are described in the following table:  
Name  
Description  
Enable Power Capping  
, the system monitors how much power is allocated to the server and  
takes the specified action if the server goes over its maximum allotment.  
Peak Power  
The maximum number of watts that can be allocated to this server. If  
the server requests more power than specified in this field, the system  
takes the action defined in the Non-Compliance Action field.  
Enter a number of watts within the range defined by the Minimum  
Configurable Limit field and the Maximum Configurable Limit  
field.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
20  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Name  
Description  
Non-Compliance Action  
The action the system should take if power capping is enabled and the  
server requests more than its peak power allotment. This can be one of  
the following:  
• —The server is forced to reduce its power consumption by any  
means necessary. This option is available only on some C-Series  
servers.  
• —No action is taken and the server is allowed to use more power  
than specified in the Peak Power field.  
• —The server is shut down.  
• —Processes running on the server are throttled to bring the total  
power consumption down.  
This example displays the detailed power statistics:  
Server# show power-cap detail  
Cur Consumption (W): 247  
Max Consumption (W): 286  
Min Consumption (W): 229  
Minimum Configurable Limit (W): 285  
Maximum Configurable Limit (W): 1250  
Power Cap Enabled: yes  
Peak Power: 0  
Non Compliance Action: throttle  
Server#  
Power Capping Policy  
The power capping policy determines how server power consumption is actively managed. When power  
capping is enabled, the system monitors how much power is allocated to the server and attempts to keep the  
power consumption below the allocated power. If the server exceeds its maximum allotment, the power  
capping policy  
       
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope power-cap  
Enters the power cap command mode.  
Server /power-cap # set  
enabled {yes | no}  
Enables or disables the capping of power to the server.  
Specifies the maximum number  
Managing the Server  
Configuring the Power Restore Policy  
Configuring the Power Restore Policy  
The power restore policy determines how power is restored to the server after a chassis power loss.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # set policy  
{power-off | power-on |  
restore-last-state}  
Specifies the action to be taken when chassis power is restored.  
Select one of the following:  
• power-off—Server power will remain off until manually  
turned on. This is the default action.  
• power-on—Server power will be turned on when chassis  
power is restored.  
• restore-last-state—Server power will return to the state  
before chassis power was lost.  
When the selected action is power-on, you can select a delay  
in the restoration of power to the server.  
Step 3  
Server /chassis # set delay  
{fixed | random}  
(Optional)  
Specifies whether server power will be restored after a fixed  
or random time. The default is fixed. This command is accepted  
only if the power restore action is power-on.  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /chassis # set  
delay-value delay  
(Optional)  
Specifies the delay time in seconds. The range is 0 to 240; the  
default is 0.  
Server /chassis # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
This example sets the power restore policy to power-on with a fixed delay of 180 seconds (3 minutes) and  
commits the transaction:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # set policy power-on  
Server /chassis *# set delay fixed  
Server /chassis *# set delay-value 180  
Server /chassis *# commit  
Server /chassis # show detail  
Chassis:  
Power: on  
Serial Number: QCI1404A1IT  
Product Name: UCS C200 M1  
PID : R200-1120402  
UUID: 01A6E738-D8FE-DE11-76AE-8843E138AE04  
Locator LED: off  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing the Server  
Managing the Flexible Flash Controller  
Description: Testing power restore  
Power Restore Policy: power-on  
Power Delay Type: fixed  
Power Delay Value(sec): 180  
Server /chassis #  
Managing the Flexible Flash Controller  
Cisco Flexible Flash  
Some C-Series Rack-Mount Servers support an internal Secure Digital (SD) memory card for storage of server  
software tools and utilities. The SD card is hosted by the Cisco Flexible Flash storage adapter.  
The SD storage is available to CIMC as four virtual USB drives. Three are preloaded with Cisco software  
and the fourth can hold a user-installed hypervisor or other content. The four virtual drives are as follows:  
Cisco UCS Server Configuration Utility (bootable)  
User-installed (may be bootable)  
•
•
•
•
Cisco drivers (not bootable)  
Cisco Host Upgrade Utility (bootable)  
For information about the Cisco software utilities and packages, see the Cisco UCS C-Series Servers  
Documentation Roadmap at this URL:  
Dual Card Management in the Cisco Flexible Flash Controller  
The Cisco Flexible Flash controller supports management of two SD cards as a RAID-1 pair. With the  
introduction of dual card management, you can perform the following tasks:  
Action  
Description  
Reset Cisco Flex Flash  
Allows you to reset the controller.  
Reset Configuration  
Allows you to reset the configuration in the selected  
slot to the default configuration.  
Retain Configuration  
Allows you to retain the configuration for an SD card  
that supports firmware version 1.2.253.  
Configure Operational Profile  
Allows you to configure the SD cards on the selected  
Cisco Flexible Flash controller.  
RAID Partition Enumeration  
Non-RAID partitions are always enumerated from the primary card and the enumeration does not depend on  
the status of the primary card.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
24  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Managing the Server  
Configuring the Flexible Flash Controller Properties  
Following is the behavior of the RAID partition enumeration when there are two cards in the Cisco Flexible  
Flash controller:  
Scenario  
Behavior  
Single card  
RAID partitions are enumerated if the card is healthy,  
and if the mode is either Primary or  
Secondary-active.  
Dual paired cards  
RAID partitions are enumerated if one of the cards  
is healthy.  
When only one card is healthy, all read/write  
operations occur on this healthy card. You must use  
UCS SCU to synchronize the two RAID partitions.  
Dual unpaired cards  
If this scenario is detected when the server is  
restarting, then neither one of the RAID partitions is  
enumerated.  
If this scenario is detected when the server is running,  
when a user connects a new SD card, then the cards  
are not managed by the Cisco Flexible Flash  
controller. This does not affect the host enumeration.  
You must pair the cards to manage them. You can  
pair the cards using the Reset Configuration or  
Retain Configuration options.  
Configuring the Flexible Flash Controller Properties  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Cisco Flexible Flash must be supported by your platform.  
•
•
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope flexflash  
index  
Enters the Cisco Flexible Flash controller command mode  
for the specified controller. At this time, the only permissible  
index value is FlexFlash-0.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/flexflash # scope  
operational-profile  
Enters the operational profile command mode.  
Server  
Specifies the slot in which the primary copy of the data  
/chassis/flexflash/operational-profile resides.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing the Server  
Configuring the Flexible Flash Controller Properties  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Important  
Currently, Cisco Flexible Flash cards are  
supported in slot 1 and slot 2. Therefore, you  
can specify slot1 or slot2.  
# set raid-primary-member {slot1  
| slot2}  
Step 5  
Step 6  
Server  
The role of the secondary RAID. The currently supported  
/chassis/flexflash/operational-profile value is active.  
# set raid-secondary-role {active |  
initializing}  
Server  
Specifies the number of read errors that are permitted while  
/chassis/flexflash/operational-profile accessing the Cisco Flexible Flash card. If the number of  
# set read-error-count-threshold errors exceeds this threshold, the Cisco Flexible Flash card  
is disabled and you must reset it manually before CIMC  
attempts to access it again.  
To specify a read error threshold, enter an integer between  
1 and 255. To specify that the card should never be disabled  
regardless of the number of errors encountered, enter 0 (zero).  
Step 7  
Server  
Specifies the number of write errors that are permitted while  
/chassis/flexflash/operational-profile accessing the Cisco Flexible Flash card. If the number of  
# set write-error-count-threshold errors exceeds this threshold, the Cisco Flexible Flash card  
is disabled and you must reset it manually before CIMC  
attempts to access it again.  
To specify a write error threshold, enter an integer between  
1 and 255. To specify that the card should never be disabled  
regardless of the number of errors encountered, enter 0 (zero).  
Step 8  
Server  
Specifies a list of virtual drives to be made available to the  
/chassis/flexflash/operational-profile server as a USB-style drive. The options are as follows:  
# set virtual-drives-enabled list  
• SCU—The server can access the Cisco UCS Server  
Configuration Utility.  
• DRIVERS—The server can access the Cisco drivers  
volume.  
• HV—The server can access a user-installed hypervisor.  
• HUU—The server can access the Cisco Host Upgrade  
Utility.  
When specifying more than one option, you must enclose  
the list in quotation marks (").  
Step 9  
Server /chassis/adapter # commit Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
This example shows how to configure the properties of the Flash controller:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope flexflash FlexFlash-0  
Server /chassis/flexflash # scope operational-profile  
Server /chassis/flexflash/operational-profile # set read-error-count-threshold 100  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
26  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing the Server  
Booting from the Flexible Flash  
Server /chassis/flexflash/operational-profile # set write-error-count-threshold 100  
Server /chassis/flexflash/operational-profile *# set raid-primary-member slot1  
Server /chassis/flexflash/operational-profile # set raid-secondary-role active  
Server /chassis/flexflash/operational-profile *# set virtual-drives-enabled "SCU HUU"  
Server /chassis/flexflash/operational-profile *# commit  
Server /chassis/flexflash/operational-profile #  
Booting from the Flexible Flash  
You can specify a bootable virtual drive on the Cisco Flexible Flash card that will override the default boot  
priority the next time the server is restarted, regardless of the default boot order defined for the server. The  
specified boot device is used only once. After the server has rebooted, this setting is ignored.  
Note  
Before you reboot the server, ensure that the virtual drive you select is enabled on the Cisco Flexible Flash  
card.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Cisco Flexible Flash must be supported by your platform.  
•
•
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope bios  
Enters the BIOS command mode.  
Server /bios # set boot-override The virtual drive from which the server attempts to boot the  
{None | SCU | HV | HUU}  
next time it is restarted. This can be one of the following:  
• None—The server uses the default boot order  
• SCU—The server boots from the Cisco UCS Server  
Configuration Utility  
• HV—The server boots from the hypervisor virtual drive  
• HUU—The server boots from the Cisco Host Upgrade  
Utility  
Step 3  
Server /bios # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
This example specifies that the server boots from the Cisco UCS Server Configuration Utility the next time  
it is restarted:  
Server# scope bios  
Server /bios # set boot-override SCU  
Committing the boot override BIOS will try boot to  
the specified boot device first. Failure to detect  
the boot device BIOS will boot from the list  
configured in the BIOS boot order.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing the Server  
Resetting the Flexible Flash Controller  
Server /bios *# commit  
Server /bios #  
Resetting the Flexible Flash Controller  
In normal operation, it should not be necessary to reset the Cisco Flexible Flash. We recommend that you  
perform this procedure only when explicitly directed to do so by a technical support representative.  
Note  
This operation will disrupt traffic to the virtual drives on the Cisco Flexible Flash controller.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Cisco Flexible Flash must be supported by your platform.  
•
•
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope flexflash  
index  
Enters the Cisco Flexible Flash controller command  
mode for the specified controller. At this time, the only  
permissible index value is FlexFlash-0.  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/flexflash # reset  
Resets the Cisco Flexible Flash controller.  
This example resets the flash controller:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope flexflash FlexFlash-0  
Server /chassis/flexflash # reset  
This operation will reset Cisco Flexible Flash controller.  
Host traffic to VDs on this device will be disrupted.  
Continue?[y|N] y  
Server /chassis/flexflash #  
Resetting the Configuration of the Cards in the Cisco Flexible Flash Controller  
You can reset the configuration of a selected slot in the Cisco Flexible Flash controller to the default  
configuration.  
When you reset the configuration of the slots in the Cisco Flexible Flash card, the following situations occur:  
The card in the selected slot is marked as primary healthy.  
The card in the other slot is marked as secondary-active unhealthy.  
Three non-RAID partitions and one RAID partition are created.  
•
•
•
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
28  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Managing the Server  
Retaining the Configuration of the Flexible Flash Controller  
The card read/write error counts and read/write threshold are set to 0.  
•
•
Host connectivity could be disrupted.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
•
•
Cisco Flexible Flash must be supported on your server.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope flexflash index Enters the Cisco Flexible Flash controller command  
mode for the specified controller. At this time, the  
only permissible index value is FlexFlash-0.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/flexflash # reset-config Resets the configuration of the selected slot to the  
primary slot ID  
default configuration.  
Server /chassis/flexflash # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
This example shows how to reset the configuration from a slot to the default configuration:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope flexflash FlexFlash-0  
Server /chassis/flexflash # reset-config slot1  
This action will mark the slot1 as the healthy primary slot, and slot2 (if card exists)  
as unhealthy secondary active.  
This operation may disturb the host connectivity as well.  
Continue? [y|N] y  
Server /chassis/flexflash/operational-profile *# commit  
Server /chassis/flexflash/operational-profile #  
Retaining the Configuration of the Flexible Flash Controller  
You can copy the configuration of a given slot in the Cisco Flexible Flash card to the other slot. However,  
the slot from which the configuration is copied from must be of the SDK523 type. You can retain the  
configuration in the following situations:  
There are two unpaired SD cards  
•
•
•
The server is operating from a single SD card, and an unpaired SD card is in the other slot.  
One SD card supports firmware version 1.2.253, and the other SD card is either unpartitioned or supports  
firmware version 1.2.247.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
•
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing the Server  
Configuring BIOS Settings  
Cisco Flexible Flash must be supported on your server.  
•
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope flexflash index Enters the Cisco Flexible Flash controller command  
mode for the specified controller. At this time, the  
only permissible index value is FlexFlash-0.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/flexflash # retain  
config primary slot ID  
Copies the configuration from the primary slot to the  
secondary slot.  
Server /chassis/flexflash # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
This example shows how to copy the configuration from one slot to the other:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope flexflash FlexFlash-0  
Server /chassis/flexflash # retain-config slot1  
This action will copy the config of slot1 to both the slots, mark slot1 as healthy,  
primary slot and slot2 (card must be present) as unhealthy secondary active.  
This operation may disturb the host connectivity as well.  
Continue? [y|N] y  
Server /chassis/flexflash/operational-profile *# commit  
Server /chassis/flexflash/operational-profile #  
Configuring BIOS Settings  
Viewing BIOS Status  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope bios  
Enters the BIOS command mode.  
Server /bios # show detail  
Displays details of the BIOS status.  
The BIOS status information contains the following fields:  
Name  
Description  
BIOS Version  
The version string of the running BIOS.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
30  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Managing the Server  
Configuring Main BIOS Settings  
Name  
Description  
Boot Order  
The order of bootable target types that the server will  
attempt to use.  
Boot Override Priority  
This can be None, SCU, HV, or HUU.  
FW Update/Recovery Status  
The status of any pending firmware update or  
recovery action.  
FW Update/Recovery Progress  
The percentage of completion of the most recent  
firmware update or recovery action.  
This example displays the BIOS status:  
Server# scope bios  
Server /bios # show detail  
BIOS Version: "C460M1.1.2.2a.0 (Build Date: 01/12/2011)"  
Boot Order: EFI,CDROM,HDD  
Boot Override Priority:  
FW Update/Recovery Status: NONE  
FW Update/Recovery Progress: 100  
Server /bios #  
Configuring Main BIOS Settings  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope bios  
Enters the BIOS command mode.  
Server /bios # scope main Enters the main BIOS settings command mode.  
Configure the BIOS  
settings.  
The BIOS parameters available depend on the model of the server  
that you are using. For descriptions and information about the options  
for each BIOS setting, see one the following topics:  
183  
•
Main BIOS Parameters for C200 and C210 Servers  
Main BIOS Parameters for C250 Servers  
•
•
•
•
Step 4  
Server /bios/main #  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
commit  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OL-28893-01  
31  
   
Managing the Server  
Configuring Advanced BIOS Settings  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Changes are applied on the next server reboot. If server power is  
on, you are prompted to choose whether to reboot now.  
This example configures the BIOS to pause the boot upon a critical POST error and commits the transaction:  
Server# scope bios  
Server /bios # scope main  
Server /bios/main # set POSTErrorPause Enabled  
Server /bios/main *# commit  
Changes to BIOS set-up parameters will require a reboot.  
Do you want to reboot the system?[y|N] n  
Changes will be applied on next reboot.  
Server /bios/main #  
Configuring Advanced BIOS Settings  
Note  
Depending on your installed hardware, some configuration options described in this topic may not appear.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope bios  
Enters the BIOS command mode.  
Server /bios # scope  
Enters the advanced BIOS settings command mode.  
advanced  
Step 3  
Configure the BIOS  
settings.  
The BIOS parameters available depend on the model of the server  
that you are using. For descriptions and information about the  
options for each BIOS setting, see one the following topics:  
page 184  
•
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C200 and C210 Servers  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C250 Servers  
•
•
•
•
Step 4  
Server /bios/advanced #  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
commit  
Changes are applied on the next server reboot. If server power is  
on, you are prompted to choose whether to reboot now.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
32  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing the Server  
Configuring Server Management BIOS Settings  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
This example enables low voltage DDR memory mode and commits the transaction:  
Server# scope bios  
Server /bios # scope advanced  
Server /bios/advanced # set LvDDRMode Enabled  
Server /bios/advanced *# commit  
Changes to BIOS set-up parameters will require a reboot.  
Do you want to reboot the system?[y|N] n  
Changes will be applied on next reboot.  
Server /bios/advanced #  
Configuring Server Management BIOS Settings  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope bios  
Enters the BIOS command mode.  
Server /bios # scope  
Enters the server management BIOS settings command mode.  
server-management  
Step 3  
Configure the BIOS settings. The BIOS parameters available depend on the model of the server  
that you are using. For descriptions and information about the  
options for each BIOS setting, see one the following topics:  
Servers , on page 200  
•
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C200 and C210  
Servers  
•
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C250 Servers  
•
•
page 232  
page 263  
•
Step 4  
Server  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
/bios/server-management #  
commit  
Changes are applied on the next server reboot. If server power is  
on, you are prompted to choose whether to reboot now.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing the Server  
Restoring BIOS Defaults  
This example enables automatic detection of the BMC and commits the transaction:  
Server# scope bios  
Server /bios # scope server-management  
Server /bios/server-management # set BMCPnP Enabled  
Server /bios/server-management *# commit  
Changes to BIOS set-up parameters will require a reboot.  
Do you want to reboot the system?[y|N] n  
Changes will be applied on next reboot.  
Server /bios/server-management #  
Restoring BIOS Defaults  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope bios  
Enters the BIOS command mode.  
Server /bios # bios-setup-default  
Restores BIOS default settings. This command  
initiates a reboot.  
This example restores BIOS default settings:  
Server# scope bios  
Server /bios # bios-setup-default  
This operation will reset the BIOS set-up tokens to factory defaults.  
All your configuration will be lost.  
Changes to BIOS set-up parameters will initiate a reboot.  
Continue?[y|N]y  
Restoring BIOS Manufacturing Custom Defaults  
In instances where the components of the BIOS no longer function as desired, you can restore the BIOS set  
up tokens to the manufacturing default values.  
Note  
This action is only available for some C-Series servers.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
The server must be powered off.  
•
•
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
34  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Managing the Server  
Restoring BIOS Manufacturing Custom Defaults  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope bios  
Enters the BIOS command mode.  
Server /bios # restore-mfg-defaults  
Restores the set up tokens to the manufacturing  
default values.  
This example shows how to restore the BIOS set up tokens to the manufacturing default values:  
Server # scope bios  
Server /bios # restore-mfg-defaults  
This operation will reset the BIOS set-up tokens to manufacturing defaults.  
The system will be powered on.  
Continue? [y|n] N  
Server /bios #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing the Server  
Restoring BIOS Manufacturing Custom Defaults  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
36  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
C H A P T E R  
4
Viewing Server Properties  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Viewing Server Properties  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Server# show chassis [detail]  
Purpose  
Displays server properties.  
Step 1  
This example displays server properties:  
Server# show chassis detail  
Chassis:  
Power: on  
Serial Number: QCI140205ZG  
Product Name: UCS C210 M2  
PID : R210-2121605W  
UUID: FFFFFFFF-FFFF-FFFF-FFFF-FFFFFFFFFFFF  
Locator LED: off  
Description:  
Power Restore Policy: power-off  
Power Delay Type: fixed  
Power Delay Value(sec): 0  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Viewing Server Properties  
Viewing CIMC Properties  
Server#  
Viewing CIMC Properties  
Note  
CIMC gets the current date and time from the server BIOS. To change this information, reboot the server  
and press F2 when prompted to access the BIOS configuration menu. Then change the date or time using  
the options on the main BIOS configuration tab.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Server# show cimc [detail]  
Displays CIMC properties.  
This example displays CIMC properties:  
Server# show cimc detail  
CIMC:  
Firmware Version: 1.4(2.18)  
Current Time: Wed Jan 11 07:01:50 2012  
Boot-loader Version: 1.4(2.18).16  
Server#  
Viewing CPU Properties  
Before You Begin  
The server must be powered on, or the properties will not display.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # show cpu [detail]  
Displays CPU properties.  
This example displays CPU properties:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show cpu  
Name  
Cores  
Version  
------------ -------- --------------------------------------------------  
CPU1  
CPU2  
4
4
Intel(R) Xeon(R) CPU  
Intel(R) Xeon(R) CPU  
E5520 @ 2.27GHz  
E5520 @ 2.27GHz  
Server /chassis #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
38  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Viewing Server Properties  
Viewing Memory Properties  
Viewing Memory Properties  
Before You Begin  
The server must be powered on, or the properties will not display.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters chassis command mode.  
Displays memory properties.  
Server /chassis # show dimm [detail]  
Server /chassis # show dimm-summary  
Displays DIMM summary information.  
This example displays memory properties:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show dimm  
Name  
Capacity  
Channel Speed (MHz) Channel Type  
-------------------- --------------- ------------------- ---------------  
DIMM_A1  
DIMM_A2  
DIMM_B1  
DIMM_B2  
DIMM_C1  
DIMM_C2  
DIMM_D1  
DIMM_D2  
DIMM_E1  
DIMM_E2  
DIMM_F1  
DIMM_F2  
2048 MB  
1067  
Other  
Other  
Other  
Other  
Other  
Other  
Other  
Other  
Other  
Other  
Other  
Other  
2048 MB  
1067  
2048 MB  
2048 MB  
1067  
1067  
Not Installed  
Not Installed  
2048 MB  
Unknown  
Unknown  
1067  
2048 MB  
1067  
2048 MB  
1067  
2048 MB  
1067  
Not Installed  
Not Installed  
Unknown  
Unknown  
Server /chassis #  
This example displays detailed information about memory properties:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show dimm detail  
Name DIMM_A1:  
Capacity: 2048 MB  
Channel Speed (MHz): 1067  
Channel Type: Other  
Memory Type Detail: Synchronous  
Bank Locator: NODE 0 CHANNEL 0 DIMM 0  
Visibility: Yes  
Operability: Operable  
Manufacturer: 0x802C  
Part Number: 18JSF25672PY-1G1D1  
Serial Number: 0xDA415F3F  
Asset Tag: Unknown  
Data Width: 64 bits  
Name DIMM_A2:  
Capacity: 2048 MB  
--More--  
Server /chassis #  
This example displays DIMM summary information:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show dimm-summary  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Viewing Server Properties  
Viewing Power Supply Properties  
DIMM Summary:  
Memory Speed: 1067 MHz  
Total Memory: 16384 MB  
Effective Memory: 16384 MB  
Redundant Memory: 0 MB  
Failed Memory: 0 MB  
Ignored Memory: 0 MB  
Number of Ignored Dimms: 0  
Number of Failed Dimms: 0  
Memory RAS possible: Memory configuration can support mirroring  
Memory Configuration: Maximum Performance  
Server /chassis #  
Viewing Power Supply Properties  
Before You Begin  
The server must be powered on, or the properties will not display.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show psu [detail]  
Displays power supply properties.  
This example displays power supply properties:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show psu  
Name  
In. Power (Watts)  
Out. Power (Watts)  
Firmware Status  
---------- -------------------- -------------------- -------- ----------  
PSU1  
PSU2  
74  
83  
650  
650  
R0E  
R0E  
Present  
Present  
Server /chassis #  
Viewing Storage Properties  
Viewing Storage Adapter Properties  
Before You Begin  
The server must be powered on, or the properties will not display.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
40  
OL-28893-01  
         
Viewing Server Properties  
Viewing Storage Adapter Properties  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Displays installed storage cards.  
Server /chassis # show storageadapter  
[slot] [detail]  
Note  
This command displays all MegaRAID  
controllers on the server that can be  
managed through CIMC. If an installed  
controller or storage device is not  
displayed, then it cannot be managed  
through CIMC.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Step 6  
Step 7  
Step 8  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot Enters command mode for an installed storage  
card.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show bbu Displays battery backup unit information for the  
[detail]  
storage card.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show  
capabilites [detail]  
Displays RAID levels supported by the storage  
card.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show  
error-counters [detail]  
Displays number of errors seen by the storage  
card.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show  
firmware-versions [detail]  
Displays firmware version information for the  
storage card.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show  
hw-config [detail]  
Displays hardware information for the storage  
card.  
Step 9  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show  
mfg-data [detail]  
Displays manufacturer data for the storage card.  
Step 10  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show  
pci-info [detail]  
Displays adapter PCI information for the storage  
card.  
Step 11  
Step 12  
Step 13  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show  
running-firmware-images [detail]  
Displays running firmware information for the  
storage card.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show  
settings [detail]  
Displays adapter firmware settings for the storage  
card.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show  
startup-firmware-images [detail]  
Displays firmware images to be activated on  
startup for the storage card.  
This example displays storage properties:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show storageadapter  
PCI Slot Product Name  
Serial Number Firmware Package Build  
-------- ---------------------------------- -------------- -------------------------  
SAS  
LSI MegaRAID SAS 9260-8i  
SV93404392  
12.12.0-0038  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Viewing Server Properties  
Viewing the Flexible Flash Controller Properties  
Product ID  
Battery Status Cache Memory Size  
---- -------------- -------------- --------------  
LSI Logic  
fully charged 0 MB  
Server /chassis #  
This example displays battery backup unit information for the storage card named SAS:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SAS  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show bbu  
Controller Battery Type Battery Present Voltage  
---------- ------------ --------------- ---------- ---------- ------ --------------  
SAS iBBU true 4.051 V 0.000 A 100% fully charged  
Current  
Charge Charging State  
Server /chassis/storageadapter #  
Viewing the Flexible Flash Controller Properties  
Before You Begin  
Cisco Flexible Flash must be supported by your platform.  
•
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show flexflash [detail] (Optional) Displays the available Cisco Flexible  
Flash controllers.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis # scope flexflash index Enters the Cisco Flexible Flash controller command  
mode for the specified controller. At this time, the  
only permissible index value is FlexFlash-0.  
Server /chassis/flexflash # show  
Displays the operational profile properties.  
operational-profile [detail]  
This example displays the properties of the flash controller:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show flexflash  
Controller  
------------ ---------------- ---------- ----------------- -------- ---------------  
FlexFlash-0 Cisco FlexFlash No 1.2 build 247 Cypress Connected  
Product Name  
Has Error Firmware Version Vendor  
Internal State  
Server /chassis # scope flexflash FlexFlash-0  
Server /chassis # show operational-profile  
Primary Member Slot I/O Error Threshold Host Accessible VDs  
-------------------- -------------------- --------------------  
slot1  
100  
SCU Drivers  
Server /chassis/flexflash #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
42  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Viewing Server Properties  
Viewing Physical Drive Properties  
Viewing Physical Drive Properties  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot  
Enters command mode for an installed  
storage card.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Step 6  
Step 7  
Step 8  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show  
physical-drive [drive-number] [detail]  
Displays physical drive information for the  
storage card.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show  
physical-drive-count [detail]  
Displays the number of physical drives on  
the storage card.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope  
physical-drive drive-number  
Enters command mode for the specified  
physical drive.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive# Displays general information about the  
show general [detail] specified physical drive.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive# Displays inquiry data about the specified  
show inquiry-data [detail] physical drive.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive# Displays status information about the  
show status [detail] specified physical drive.  
This example displays general information about physical drive number 1 on the storage card named SAS:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SAS  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope physical-drive 1  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive # show general  
Slot Number 1:  
Controller: SAS  
Enclosure Device ID: 27  
Device ID: 34  
Sequence Number: 2  
Media Error Count: 0  
Other Error Count: 0  
Predictive Failure Count: 0  
Link Speed: 6.0 Gb/s  
Interface Type: SAS  
Media Type: HDD  
Block Size: 512  
Block Count: 585937500  
Raw Size: 286102 MB  
Non Coerced Size: 285590 MB  
Coerced Size: 285568 MB  
SAS Address 0: 500000e112693fa2  
SAS Address 1:  
Connected Port 0:  
Connected Port 1:  
Connected Port 2:  
Connected Port 3:  
Connected Port 4:  
Connected Port 5:  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Viewing Server Properties  
Viewing Virtual Drive Properties  
Connected Port 6:  
Connected Port 7:  
Power State: powersave  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive #  
This example displays inquiry data about physical drive number 1 on the storage card named SAS:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SAS  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope physical-drive 1  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive # show inquiry-data  
Slot Number 1:  
Controller: SAS  
Product ID: MBD2300RC  
Drive Firmware: 5701  
Drive Serial Number: D010P9A0016D  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive #  
This example displays status information about physical drive number 1 on the storage card named SAS:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SAS  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope physical-drive 1  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive # show inquiry-data  
Slot Number 1:  
Controller: SAS  
State: online  
Online: true  
Fault: false  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive #  
Viewing Virtual Drive Properties  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot Enters command mode for an installed storage  
card.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Step 6  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show  
virtual-drive [drive-number] [detail]  
Displays virtual drive information for the  
storage card.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show  
virtual-drive-count [detail]  
Displays the number of virtual drives  
configured on the storage card.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope  
virtual-drive drive-number  
Enters command mode for the specified  
virtual drive.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive # Displays physical drive information about the  
show physical-drive [detail] specified virtual drive.  
This example displays information about virtual drives on the storage card named SAS:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SAS  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show virtual-drive  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
44  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Viewing Server Properties  
Viewing Nvidia GPU Card Information  
Virtual Drive Status  
Name  
Size  
RAID Level  
-------------- --------------- ------------------------ ---------- ----------  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Optimal  
Optimal  
Optimal  
Optimal  
Optimal  
Optimal  
Optimal  
Optimal  
Optimal  
SLES1SP1beta5  
RHEL5.5  
W2K8R2_DC  
VD_3  
ESX4.0u2  
VMs  
RHEL6-35GB  
OS_Ins_Test_DR  
30720 MB  
30720 MB  
30720 MB  
30720 MB  
30720 MB  
285568 MB RAID 0  
35840 MB RAID 0  
RAID 0  
RAID 0  
RAID 0  
RAID 0  
RAID 0  
158720 MB RAID 0  
285568 MB RAID 1  
Server /chassis/storageadapter #  
This example displays physical drive information about virtual drive number 1 on the storage card named  
SAS:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SAS  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope virtual-drive 1  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive # show physical-drive  
Span Physical Drive Status  
----- -------------- ---------- -------------- ----------------  
12 online 62914560 62914560  
Starting Block Number Of Blocks  
0
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive #  
Viewing Nvidia GPU Card Information  
These commands are not available on all UCS C-series servers.  
Before You Begin  
The server must be powered on to view information on the Nvidia GPU cards.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # show gpu  
Displays the available Nvidia GPU cards on the  
system.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis # scope gpu  
slot-number  
Enters the GPU card command mode. Specify the  
slot number of the GPU card.  
Server /chassis/gpu # show gpu-list  
Displays temperature information on the GPU  
cards.  
This example shows how to view the temperature information of the available GPU cards on the system:  
Server # scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show gpu  
Slot  
----  
5
Product Name  
Num of GPUs  
-----------  
2
------------  
Nvidia GRID K2 @ BD  
Server /chassis # scope gpu 5  
Server /chassis/gpu # show gpu-list  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OL-28893-01  
45  
   
Viewing Server Properties  
Viewing PCI Adapter Properties  
GPU ID  
------  
Temperature  
-----------  
0
1
32  
33  
Server /chassis/gpu #  
Viewing PCI Adapter Properties  
Before You Begin  
The server must be powered on, or the properties will not display.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show pci-adapter [detail] Displays PCI adapter properties.  
This example displays PCI adapter properties:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show pci-adapter  
Name  
Slot Vendor ID  
Device ID  
Product Name  
---------------- ----- ------------ ------------ -------------------------  
PCIe Adapter1  
PCIe Adapter2  
1
5
0x1137  
0x1077  
0x0042  
0x2432  
Cisco UCS P81E Virtual...  
Qlogic QLE2462 4Gb dua...  
Server /chassis #  
Viewing Network Related Properties  
Viewing LOM Properties  
You can view the MAC addresses of the LAN On Motherboard (LOM) Ethernet ports.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Server /cimc # scope network  
Enters the network command mode.  
Server /cimc/network # show lom-mac-list Displays the MAC addresses of the LOM  
[detail]  
ports.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
46  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Viewing Server Properties  
Viewing LOM Properties  
This example shows how to display the MAC addresses of the LOM ports:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope network  
Server /cimc/network # show lom-mac-list  
Interface  
MAC Address  
--------------- --------------------  
eth0  
eth1  
010000002000  
010000002000  
Server /cimc/network #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OL-28893-01  
47  
Viewing Server Properties  
Viewing LOM Properties  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
48  
OL-28893-01  
C H A P T E R  
5
Viewing Server Sensors  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
•
•
•
Viewing Power Supply Sensors  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope sensor  
Enters sensor command mode.  
Server /sensor # show psu [detail]  
Displays power supply sensor statistics for the  
server.  
Step 3  
Server /sensor # show psu-redundancy Displays power supply redundancy sensor status  
[detail]  
for the server.  
This example displays power supply sensor statistics:  
Server# scope sensor  
Server /sensor # show psu  
Name  
Min. Failure  
Sensor Status  
Max. Failure  
Reading  
Units  
Min. Warning  
Max. Warning  
-------------------- -------------------- ---------- ---------- ---------------  
--------------- --------------- ---------------  
PSU1_STATUS  
Normal  
present  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OL-28893-01  
49  
     
Viewing Server Sensors  
Viewing Fan Sensors  
PSU2_STATUS  
Normal  
present  
Server /sensor # show psu-redundancy  
Name Reading Sensor Status  
-------------------- ---------- --------------------  
PSU_REDUNDANCY  
full  
Normal  
Server /sensor #  
Viewing Fan Sensors  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope sensor  
Enters sensor command mode.  
Server /sensor # show fan [detail]  
Displays fan sensor statistics for the server.  
This example displays fan sensor statistics:  
Server# scope sensor  
Server /sensor # show fan  
Name  
Sensor Status Reading  
Max. Failure  
Units  
Min. Warning  
Max. Warning  
Min. Failure  
-------------------- -------------- ---------- ---------- --------------- ---------------  
--------------- ---------------  
W793_FAN2_TACH1  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
2400  
2400  
2300  
2300  
2400  
1600  
RPM  
RPM  
RPM  
RPM  
RPM  
RPM  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
800  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
W793_FAN2_TACH2  
800  
W793_FAN3_TACH1  
800  
W793_FAN3_TACH2  
800  
W793_FAN4_TACH1  
800  
W793_FAN4_TACH2  
800  
Server /sensor #  
Viewing Temperature Sensors  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters sensor command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope sensor  
Server /sensor # show temperature [detail] Displays temperature sensor statistics for the  
server.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
50  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Viewing Server Sensors  
Viewing Voltage Sensors  
This example displays temperature sensor statistics:  
Server# scope sensor  
Server /sensor # show temperature  
Name  
Sensor Status Reading  
Units  
Min. Warning Max. Warning  
Min. Failure Max. Failure  
------------------------- -------------- ---------- ---------- ------------ ------------  
------------ ------------  
IOH_TEMP_SENS  
N/A  
P2_TEMP_SENS  
N/A  
P1_TEMP_SENS  
N/A  
DDR3_P2_D1_TMP  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
32.0  
31.0  
34.0  
20.0  
21.0  
28.0  
C
C
C
C
C
C
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
80.0  
80.0  
80.0  
90.0  
90.0  
40.0  
85.0  
81.0  
81.0  
N/A  
95.0  
DDR3_P1_A1_TMP  
N/A  
95.0  
FP_AMBIENT_TEMP  
N/A  
45.0  
Server /sensor #  
Viewing Voltage Sensors  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope sensor  
Enters sensor command mode.  
Server /sensor # show voltage [detail]  
Displays voltage sensor statistics for the  
server.  
This example displays voltage sensor statistics:  
Server# scope sensor  
Server /sensor # show voltage  
Name  
Sensor Status Reading  
Units  
Min. Warning Max. Warning  
Min. Failure Max. Failure  
------------------------- -------------- ---------- ---------- ------------ ------------  
------------ ------------  
P3V_BAT_SCALED  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
3.022  
12.154  
5.036  
3.318  
5.109  
0.950  
0.891  
1.499  
1.499  
1.087  
1.773  
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
2.798  
3.088  
P12V_SCALED  
11.623  
P5V_SCALED  
4.844  
P3V3_SCALED  
3.191  
12.331  
5.157  
3.381  
P5V_STBY_SCALED  
4.844  
5.157  
PV_VCCP_CPU1  
0.725  
1.391  
1.391  
PV_VCCP_CPU2  
0.725  
P1V5_DDR3_CPU1  
1.450  
1.548  
P1V5_DDR3_CPU2  
1.450  
1.548  
P1V1_IOH  
1.068  
P1V8_AUX  
1.136  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Viewing Server Sensors  
Viewing Current Sensors  
1.744  
1.852  
Server /sensor #  
Viewing Current Sensors  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope sensor  
Enters sensor command mode.  
Server /sensor # show current [detail]  
Displays current sensor statistics for the server.  
This example displays current sensor statistics:  
Server# scope sensor  
Server /sensor # show current  
Name  
Sensor Status Reading  
Units  
Min. Warning Max. Warning  
Min. Failure Max. Failure  
------------------------- -------------- ---------- ---------- ------------ ------------  
------------ ------------  
VR_P2_IMON  
N/A  
VR_P1_IMON  
N/A  
Normal  
16.00  
AMP  
N/A  
147.20  
164.80  
164.80  
Normal  
27.20  
AMP  
N/A  
147.20  
Server /sensor #  
Viewing Storage Sensors  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # show hdd [detail]  
Displays storage sensor information.  
The displayed fields are described in the following table:  
Name  
Description  
Name column  
The name of the storage device.  
Status column  
A brief description of the storage device status.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
52  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Viewing Server Sensors  
Viewing Storage Sensors  
Name  
Description  
LED Status column  
The current LED color, if any.  
To make the physical LED on the storage device blink, select Turn On  
from the drop-down list. To let the storage device control whether the  
LED blinks, select Turn Off.  
Note  
This information is only available for some C-Series  
servers.  
This example displays storage sensor information:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show hdd  
Name  
Status  
-------------------- --------------------  
HDD_01_STATUS  
HDD_02_STATUS  
HDD_03_STATUS  
HDD_04_STATUS  
present  
present  
present  
present  
Server /chassis #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Viewing Server Sensors  
Viewing Storage Sensors  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
54  
OL-28893-01  
C H A P T E R  
6
Managing Remote Presence  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
Managing the Virtual KVM  
KVM Console  
The KVM console is an interface accessible from CIMC that emulates a direct keyboard, video, and mouse  
(KVM) connection to the server. The KVM console allows you to connect to the server from a remote location.  
Instead of using CD/DVD or floppy drives physically connected to the server, the KVM console uses virtual  
media, which are actual disk drives or disk image files that are mapped to virtual CD/DVD or floppy drives.  
You can  
       
Managing Remote Presence  
Enabling the Virtual KVM  
Enabling the Virtual KVM  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to enable the virtual KVM.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope kvm  
Enters KVM command mode.  
Enables the virtual KVM.  
Server /kvm # set enabled yes  
Server /kvm # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system  
configuration.  
Step 4  
Server /kvm # show [detail]  
(Optional) Displays the virtual KVM  
configuration.  
This example enables the virtual KVM:  
Server# scope kvm  
Server /kvm # set enabled yes  
Server /kvm *# commit  
Server /kvm # show  
Encryption Enabled Local Video  
Active Sessions Enabled KVM Port  
------------------ ---------------- --------------- ------- --------  
no  
yes  
0
yes  
2068  
Server /kvm #  
Disabling the Virtual KVM  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to disable the virtual KVM.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope kvm  
Enters KVM command mode.  
Server /kvm # set enabled no  
Disables the virtual KVM.  
Note  
Disabling the virtual KVM disables access to  
the virtual media feature, but does not detach  
the virtual media devices if virtual media is  
enabled.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
56  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Managing Remote Presence  
Configuring the Virtual KVM  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /kvm # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
(Optional) Displays the virtual KVM configuration.  
Server /kvm # show [detail]  
This example disables the virtual KVM:  
Server# scope kvm  
Server /kvm # set enabled no  
Server /kvm *# commit  
Server /kvm # show  
Encryption Enabled Local Video  
Active Sessions Enabled KVM Port  
------------------ ---------------- --------------- ------- --------  
no  
yes  
0
no  
2068  
Server /kvm #  
Configuring the Virtual KVM  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to configure the virtual KVM.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope kvm  
Enters KVM command mode.  
Server /kvm # set enabled {yes | no} Enables or disables the virtual KVM.  
Server /kvm # set encrypted {yes | If encryption is enabled, the server encrypts all video  
no}  
information sent through the KVM.  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /kvm # set kvm-port port  
Specifies the port used for KVM communication.  
Server /kvm # set local-video {yes | If local video is yes, the KVM session is also  
no}  
displayed on any monitor attached to the server.  
Step 6  
Server /kvm # set max-sessions  
sessions  
Specifies the maximum number of concurrent KVM  
sessions allowed. The sessions argument is an integer  
between 1 and 4.  
Step 7  
Step 8  
Server /kvm # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
(Optional) Displays the virtual KVM configuration.  
Server /kvm # show [detail]  
This example configures the virtual KVM and displays the configuration:  
Server# scope kvm  
Server /kvm # set enabled yes  
Server /kvm *# set encrypted no  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Remote Presence  
Configuring Virtual Media  
Server /kvm *# set kvm-port 2068  
Server /kvm *# set max-sessions 4  
Server /kvm *# set local-video yes  
Server /kvm *# commit  
Server /kvm # show detail  
KVM Settings:  
Encryption Enabled: no  
Max Sessions: 4  
Local Video: yes  
Active Sessions: 0  
Enabled: yes  
KVM Port: 2068  
Server /kvm #  
What to Do Next  
Launch the virtual KVM from the GUI.  
Configuring Virtual Media  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to configure virtual media.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters virtual media command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope vmedia  
Server /vmedia # set enabled {yes | Enables or disables virtual media. By default, virtual  
no}  
media is disabled.  
Note  
Disabling virtual media detaches the virtual  
CD, virtual floppy, and virtual HDD devices  
from the host.  
Step 3  
Server /vmedia # set encryption {yes Enables or disables virtual media encryption.  
| no}  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /vmedia # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
(Optional) Displays the virtual media configuration.  
Server /vmedia # show [detail]  
This example configures virtual media encryption:  
Server# scope vmedia  
Server /vmedia # set enabled yes  
Server /vmedia *# set encryption yes  
Server /vmedia *# commit  
Server /vmedia # show detail  
vMedia Settings:  
Encryption Enabled: yes  
Enabled: yes  
Max Sessions: 1  
Active Sessions: 0  
Server /vmedia #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
58  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Remote Presence  
Configuring Network Mounted vMedia Mapping  
What to Do Next  
Use the KVM to attach virtual media devices to a host.  
Configuring Network Mounted vMedia Mapping  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server # scope vmedia  
Enters the virtual media command mode.  
Server /vmedia # map-cifs  
Maps a CIFS file for vMedia. You must specify the following:  
{volume-name | remote-share |  
remote-file-path [mount options]  
Name of the volume to create  
•
•
Remote share including IP address and the exported  
directory  
Path of the remote file corresponding to the exported  
directory.  
•
(Optional) Mapping options  
•
•
Username and password to connect to the server  
Step 3  
Server /vmedia # map-nfs  
{volume-name | remote-share |  
remote-file-path} [mount options]  
Maps an NFS file for vMedia. You must specify the  
following:  
Name of the volume to create  
•
•
Remote share including IP address and the exported  
directory  
Path of the remote file corresponding to the exported  
directory.  
•
•
(Optional) Mapping options  
Step 4  
Server /vmedia # map-www  
{volume-name | remote-share |  
remote-file-path [mount options]  
Maps an HTTPS file for vMedia. You must specify the  
following:  
Name of the volume to create  
•
•
Remote share including IP address and the exported  
directory  
Path of the remote file corresponding to the exported  
directory.  
•
•
(Optional) Mapping options  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Remote Presence  
Viewing Network Mount vMedia Mapping Properties  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Username and password to connect to the server  
•
This example shows how to create a CIFS network mounted vMedia mapping:  
Server # scope vmedia  
Server /vmedia # map-cifs sample-volume //10.10.10.10/project /test/sample  
Server username:  
Server password: ****  
Confirm password: ****  
Server /vmedia #  
Viewing Network Mount vMedia Mapping Properties  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server # scope vmedia  
Enters the virtual media command mode.  
Server /vmedia # show mappings detail Displays information on all the vmedia mapping  
that are configured.  
This example shows how to view the properties of all the configured vmedia mapping:  
Server # scope vmedia  
Server /vmedia # show mappings  
Volume Map-status  
Drive-type  
remote-share  
remote-file  
mount-type  
-----------  
------ ---------- ------------ --------------------- -------------------  
Huu  
Rhel  
OK  
OK  
removable  
CD  
http://10.104.236.99/ rhel-server-6.1-x86_6.iso  
http://10.104.236.99/ rhel-server-6.1-x86_6.iso  
www  
www  
Removing Network Mounted vMedia Mapping  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
60  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server # scope vmedia  
Enters the virtual media command mode.  
Server /vmedia # unmap volume_name  
Specifies the volume name to unmap.  
This example shows how to unmap a local vmedia volume:  
Server # scope vmedia  
Server /vmedia # show mappings  
Volume Map-status  
Drive-type  
remote-share  
remote-file  
mount-type  
-----------  
------ ---------- ------------ --------------------- -------------------  
Huu  
Rhel  
OK  
OK  
removable  
CD  
http://10.104.236.99/ rhel-server-6.1-x86_6.iso  
http://10.104.236.99/ rhel-server-6.1-x86_6.iso  
www  
www  
Server /vmedia # unmap huu  
Server /vmedia # show mappings  
Volume Map-status  
Drive-type  
remote-share  
remote-file  
mount-type  
-----------  
------ ---------- ------------ --------------------- -------------------  
Rhel OK CD  
http://10.104.236.99/ rhel-server-6.1-x86_6.iso  
www  
Server /vmedia #  
Managing Serial over LAN  
Serial Over LAN  
Serial over LAN (SoL) is a mechanism that enables the input and output of the serial port of a managed system  
to be redirected via an SSH session over IP. SoL provides a means of reaching the host console via CIMC.  
Guidelines and Restrictions for Serial Over LAN  
For redirection to SoL, the server console must have the following configuration:  
console redirection to serial port A  
no flow control  
•
•
•
•
•
baud rate the same as configured for SoL  
VT-100 terminal type  
legacy OS redirection disabled  
The SoL session will display line-oriented information such as boot messages, and character-oriented screen  
menus such as  
       
Managing Remote Presence  
Configuring Serial Over LAN  
display, such as Windows, the SoL session will no longer display. If the server boots a command-line-oriented  
operating system (OS), such as Linux, you may need to perform additional configuration of the OS in order  
to properly display in an SoL session.  
In the SoL session, your keystrokes are transmitted to the console except for the function key F2. To send an  
F2 to the console, press the Escape key, then press 2.  
Configuring Serial Over LAN  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to configure serial over LAN (SoL).  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope sol  
Enters SoL command mode.  
Server /sol # set enabled  
{yes | no}  
Enables or disables SoL on this server.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /sol # set baud-rate Sets the serial baud rate the system uses for SoL communication.  
{9600 | 19200 | 38400 |  
57600 | 115200}  
Note  
The baud rate must match the baud rate configured in the  
server serial console.  
Server /sol # set comport (Optional)  
{com0 | com1  
Sets the serial port through which the system routes SoL  
communications.  
Note  
This field is only available on some C-Series servers. If it  
is not available, the server always uses COM port 0 for  
SoL communication.  
You can specify:  
• com0—SoL communication is routed through COM port 0,  
an externally accessible serial port that supports either a  
physical RJ45 connection to an external device or a virtual  
SoL connection to a network device.  
If you select this option, the system enables SoL and disables  
the RJ45 connection, which means that the server can no  
longer support an external serial device.  
• com1—SoL communication is routed through COM port 1,  
an internal port accessible only through SoL.  
If you select this option, you can use SoL on COM port 1 and  
the physical RJ45 connection on COM port 0.  
Note  
Changing the comport setting disconnects any existing  
SoL sessions.  
Step 5  
Server /sol # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
62  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Remote Presence  
Launching Serial Over LAN  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 6  
Server /sol # show [detail] (Optional) Displays the SoL settings.  
This example configures SoL:  
Server# scope sol  
Server /sol # set enabled yes  
Server /sol *# set baud-rate 115200  
Server /sol *# commit  
Server /sol # show  
Enabled Baud Rate(bps) Com Port  
------- --------------- --------  
yes  
115200  
com2  
Server /sol # show detail  
Serial Over LAN:  
Enabled: yes  
Baud Rate(bps): 115200  
Com Port: com2  
Server /sol #  
Launching Serial Over LAN  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Server# connect host  
Opens a serial over LAN (SoL) connection to the redirected  
server console port. You can enter this command in any  
command mode.  
What to Do Next  
To end the SoL session, you must close the CLI session. For example, to end an SoL session over an SSH  
connection, disconnect the SSH connection.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Remote Presence  
Launching Serial Over LAN  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
64  
OL-28893-01  
C H A P T E R  
7
Managing User Accounts  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
•
Configuring Local Users  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to configure or modify local user accounts.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope user usernumber Enters user command mode for user number usernumber.  
Server /user # set enabled {yes Enables or disables the user account on the CIMC.  
| no}  
Step 3  
Server /user # set name  
Specifies the username for the user.  
username  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /user # set password  
You are prompted to enter the password twice.  
Server /user # set role {readonly Specifies the role assigned to the user. The roles are as  
| user | admin}  
follows:  
• readonly—This user can view information but cannot  
make any changes.  
• user—This user can do the following:  
View all information  
•
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Managing User Accounts  
Configuring Active Directory  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Manage the power control options such as power  
on, power cycle, and power off  
•
Launch the KVM console and virtual media  
Clear all logs  
•
•
•
Toggle the locator LED  
• admin—This user can perform all actions available  
through the GUI, CLI, and IPMI.  
Step 6  
Server /user # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
This example configures user 5 as an admin:  
Server# scope user 5  
Server /user # set enabled yes  
Server /user *# set name john  
Server /user *# set password  
Please enter password:  
Please confirm password:  
Server /user *# set role readonly  
Server /user *# commit  
Server /user # show  
User  
------ ---------------- -------- --------  
john readonly yes  
Name  
Role  
Enabled  
5
Configuring Active Directory  
Active Directory  
Active Directory is a technology that provides a variety of network services including LDAP-like directory  
services, Kerberos-based authentication, and DNS-based naming. The CIMC utilizes the Kerberos-based  
authentication service of Active Directory.  
When Active Directory is enabled in the CIMC, user authentication and role authorization is performed by  
Active Directory for user accounts not found in the local user database.  
you can require the server to encrypt data sent to Active Directory.  
Configuring the Active Directory Server  
The CIMC can be configured to use Active Directory for user authentication and authorization. To use Active  
Directory, configure users with an attribute that holds the user role and locale information for the CIMC. You  
can use an existing LDAP attribute that is mapped to the CIMC user roles and locales or you can modify the  
Active Directory schema to add a new custom attribute, such as the CiscoAVPair attribute, which has an  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
66  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Managing User Accounts  
Configuring the Active Directory Server  
attribute ID of 1.3.6.1.4.1.9.287247.1. For more information about altering the Active Directory schema, see  
The following steps are to be performed on the Active Directory server.  
Note  
This example creates a custom attribute named CiscoAVPair, but you can also use an existing LDAP  
attribute that is mapped to the CIMC user roles and locales.  
Procedure  
Step 1 Ensure that the Active Directory schema snap-in is installed.  
Step 2 Using the Active Directory schema snap-in, add a new attribute with the following properties:  
Properties  
Value  
Common Name  
CiscoAVPair  
LDAP Display Name  
Unique X500 Object ID  
Description  
CiscoAVPair  
1.3.6.1.4.1.9.287247.1  
CiscoAVPair  
Syntax  
Case Sensitive String  
Step 3 Add the CiscoAVPair attribute to the user class using the Active Directory snap-in:  
a) Expand the Classes node in the left pane and type U to select the user class.  
b) Click the Attributes tab and click Add.  
c) Type C to select the CiscoAVPair attribute.  
d) Click OK.  
Step 4 Add the following user role values to the CiscoAVPair attribute, for the users that you want to have access  
to CIMC:  
Role  
CiscoAVPair Attribute Value  
admin  
shell:roles="admin"  
user  
shell:roles="user"  
read-only  
shell:roles="read-only"  
Note  
For more information about adding values to attributes, see the article at http://technet.microsoft.com/  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing User Accounts  
Configuring Active Directory in CIMC  
What to Do Next  
Use the CIMC to configure Active Directory.  
Configuring Active Directory in CIMC  
Configure Active Directory (AD) in CIMC when you want to use an AD server for local user authentication  
and authorization.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope ldap  
Enters the LDAP command mode for AD configuration.  
Server /ldap # set enabled  
{yes | no}  
Enables or disables AD. When AD is enabled, user  
authentication and role authorization is performed by AD for  
user accounts not found in the local user database.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /ldap # set dcn dc-host Specifies an Active Directory domain controller (DC) host  
name or IP address. You can specify up to three DCs using  
index n values from 1 to 3.  
Server /ldap # set gcn gc-host Specifies an Active Directory global catalog (GC) server host  
name or IP address. You can specify up to three GCs using  
index n values from 1 to 3.  
Step 5  
Step 6  
Server /ldap # set timeout  
seconds  
Specifies the number of seconds the CIMC waits until the  
LDAP search operation times out.  
Server /ldap # set encrypted If encryption is enabled, the server encrypts all information  
{yes | no}  
sent to AD.  
Step 7  
Step 8  
Server /ldap # set base-dn  
domain-name  
Specifies the domain that all users must be in.  
Server /ldap # set attribute  
name  
Specify an LDAP attribute that contains the role and locale  
information for the user. This property is always a name-value  
pair. The system queries the user record for the value that  
matches this attribute name.  
You can use an existing LDAP attribute that is mapped to the  
CIMC user roles and locales or you can create a custom  
attribute, such as the CiscoAVPair attribute, which has the  
following attribute ID:  
1.3.6.1.4.1.9.287247.1  
Note  
If you do not specify this property, user access is  
restricted to read-only.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
68  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing User Accounts  
Configuring Active Directory Groups in CIMC  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
Step 9  
Step 10  
Server /ldap # commit  
Server /ldap # show [detail] (Optional) Displays the AD configuration.  
This example configures AD using the CiscoAVPair attribute:  
Server# scope ldap  
Server /ldap # set enabled yes  
Server /ldap *# set dc1 192.0.20.123  
Server /ldap *# set gc1 192.0.20.11  
Server /ldap *# set timeout 60  
Server /ldap *# set encrypted yes  
Server /ldap *# set base-dn example.com  
Server /ldap *# set attribute CiscoAVPair  
Server /ldap *# commit  
Server /ldap # show detail  
LDAP Settings:  
Domain Controller 1: 192.0.20.123  
Domain Controller 2: 0.0.0.0  
Domain Controller 3: 0.0.0.0  
BaseDN: example.com  
Encrypted: yes  
Timeout: 60  
Enabled: yes  
Attribute: CiscoAvPair  
Group Authorization: no  
Global Catalog 1: 192.0.20.11  
Global Catalog 2: 0.0.0.0  
Global Catalog 3: 0.0.0.0  
Server /ldap #  
What to Do Next  
If you want to use Active Directory groups for group authorization, see Configuring Active Directory Groups  
in CIMC.  
Configuring Active Directory Groups in CIMC  
Note  
When Active Directory (AD) group authorization is enabled and configured, user authentication is also  
done on the group level for users that are not found in the local user database or who are not individually  
authorized to use CIMC in the Active Directory.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Active Directory (or LDAP) must be enabled and configured.  
•
•
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing User Accounts  
Configuring Active Directory Groups in CIMC  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope ldap  
Enters the LDAP command mode for AD configuration.  
Enables or disables AD group authorization.  
Server /ldap # set group-auth  
{yes | no}  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /ldap # scope role-group Selects one of the five available group profiles for  
index  
configuration, where index is a number between 1 and 5.  
Server /ldap/role-group # set name Specifies the name of the group in the AD database that is  
group-name  
authorized to access the server.  
Step 5  
Step 6  
Server /ldap/role-group # set  
domain domain-name  
Specifies the AD domain the group must reside in.  
Server /ldap/role-group # set role Specifies the permission level (role) assigned to all users in  
{admin | user | readonly}  
this AD group. This can be one of the following:  
• admin—The user can perform all actions available.  
• user—The user can perform the following tasks:  
View all information  
â—¦
â—¦
Manage the power control options such as power  
on, power cycle, and power off  
Launch the KVM console and virtual media  
Clear all logs  
â—¦
â—¦
â—¦
Toggle the locator LED  
• readonly—The user can view information but cannot  
make any changes.  
Step 7  
Server /ldap/role-group # commit Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
This example shows how to configure AD group authorization:  
Server# scope ldap  
Server /ldap # set group-auth yes  
Server /ldap *# scope role-group 5  
Server /ldap/role-group *# set name Training  
Server /ldap/role-group *# set domain example.com  
Server /ldap/role-group *# set role readonly  
Server /ldap/role-group *# commit  
ucs-c250-M2 /ldap # show role-group  
Group Name  
Domain  
Role  
------ ---------------- ---------------- --------  
1
2
3
4
5
(n/a)  
(n/a)  
admin  
user  
readonly  
(n/a)  
readonly  
(n/a)  
(n/a)  
(n/a)  
(n/a)  
Training  
(n/a)  
(n/a)  
example.com  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
70  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing User Accounts  
Viewing User Sessions  
Server /ldap/role-group #  
Viewing User Sessions  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Server# show user-session  
Purpose  
Displays information about current user sessions.  
Step 1  
The command output displays the following information about current user sessions:  
Name  
Description  
Session ID column  
The unique identifier for the session.  
Username column  
IP Address column  
Type column  
The username for the user.  
The IP address from which the user accessed the server.  
The method by which the user accessed the server.  
Action column  
If your user account is assigned the admin user role, this column  
displays Terminate if you can force the associated user session to end.  
Otherwise it displays N/A.  
Note  
You cannot terminate your current session from this  
tab.  
This example displays information about current user sessions:  
Server# show user-session  
ID  
------ ---------------- ----------------- ------------ --------  
15 admin 10.20.30.138 CLI yes  
Name  
IP Address  
Type  
Killable  
Server /user #  
Terminating a User Session  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to terminate a user session.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Managing User Accounts  
Terminating a User Session  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Server# show user-session  
Displays information about current user sessions. The  
user session to be terminated must be eligible to be  
terminated (killable) and must not be your own session.  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server /user-session # scope  
user-session session-number  
Enters user session command mode for the numbered  
user session that you want to terminate.  
Server /user-session # terminate  
Terminates the user session.  
This example shows how the admin at user session 10 terminates user session 15:  
Server# show user-session  
ID  
Name  
IP Address  
Type  
Killable  
------ ---------------- ----------------- ------------ --------  
10  
15  
admin  
admin  
10.20.41.234  
10.20.30.138  
CLI  
CLI  
yes  
yes  
Server# scope user-session 15  
Server /user-session # terminate  
User session 15 terminated.  
Server /user-session #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
72  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
C H A P T E R  
8
Configuring Network-Related Settings  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Server NIC Configuration  
Server NICs  
NIC Mode  
The NIC mode setting determines which ports can reach the CIMC. The following network mode options are  
available, depending on your platform:  
• Dedicated—The management port is used to access the CIMC.  
• Shared LOM—Any LOM (LAN On Motherboard) port can be used to access the CIMC.  
• Shared LOM 10G—Any 10G LOM port can be used to access the CIMC. This option is only available  
for some adapter cards.  
• Cisco Card—Any port on the adapter card can be used to access the CIMC. The Cisco adapter card has  
to be installed in a slot with Network Communications Services Interface protocol (NCSI) support.  
• Shared LOM Extended—Any LOM port or adapter card port can be used to access the CIMC. The  
Cisco adapter card has to be installed in a slot with NCSI support.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
NIC Redundancy  
The following NIC redundancy options are available, depending on the selected NIC mode and your platform:  
• none—Each port associated with the configured NIC mode operates independently. The ports do not  
fail over if there is a problem.  
• active-active—If supported, all ports associated with the configured NIC mode operate simultaneously.  
This increases throughput and provides multiple paths to the CIMC.  
• active-standby—If a port associated with the configured NIC mode fails, traffic will fail over to one  
of the other ports associated with the NIC mode.  
Note  
If you select this option, make sure all ports associated with the configured NIC mode  
are connected to the same subnet to ensure that traffic is secure regardless of which port  
is used.  
The available redundancy modes vary depending on the selected network mode and your platform. For the  
available modes, see the Hardware Installation Guide (HIG) for the type of server you are using. The C-Series  
   
Command or Action  
Purpose  
• Cisco card—The ports on the adapter card are used to access  
the CIMC.  
Step 4  
Server /cimc/network # set Sets the NIC redundancy mode when the NIC mode is Shared  
redundancy {none |  
active-active |  
active-standby}  
LOM. The redundancy mode can be one of the following:  
• none—The LOM Ethernet ports operate independently and  
do not fail over if there is a problem.  
• active-active—If supported, all LOM Ethernet ports are  
utilized.  
• active-standby—If one LOM Ethernet port fails, traffic fails  
over to another LOM port.  
Server  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
   
Configuring Network-Related Settings  
Configuring IPv4  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 4  
Server /cimc/network # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system  
configuration.  
This example configures the common properties:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope network  
Server /cimc/network # set hostname Server  
Server /cimc/network *# commit  
Server /cimc/network #  
Configuring IPv4  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to configure IPv4 network settings.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Server /cimc # scope network  
Enters the CIMC network command mode.  
Server /cimc/network # set dhcp-enabled Selects whether the CIMC uses DHCP.  
{yes | no}  
Note  
If DHCP is enabled, we recommend that  
the DHCP server be configured to reserve  
a single IP address for the CIMC. If the  
CIMC is reachable through multiple ports  
on the server, the single IP address must  
be reserved for the full range of MAC  
addresses of those ports.  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Step 6  
Step 7  
Server /cimc/network # set v4-addr  
ipv4-address  
Specifies the IP address for the CIMC.  
Server /cimc/network # set v4-netmask Specifies the subnet mask for the IP address.  
ipv4-netmask  
Server /cimc/network # set v4-gateway Specifies the gateway for the IP address.  
gateway-ipv4-address  
Server /cimc/network # set dns-use-dhcp Selects whether the CIMC retrieves the DNS server  
{yes | no}  
addresses from DHCP.  
Step 8  
Server /cimc/network # set  
Specifies the IP address of the primary DNS server.  
preferred-dns-server dns1-ipv4-address  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
76  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Configuring Network-Related Settings  
Configuring the Server VLAN  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Specifies the IP address of the secondary DNS  
Step 9  
Server /cimc/network # set  
alternate-dns-server dns2-ipv4-address server.  
Step 10  
Step 11  
Server /cimc/network # commit Commits the transaction to the system  
configuration.  
Server /cimc/network # show [detail] (Optional) Displays the IPv4 network settings.  
This example configures and displays the IPv4 network settings:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope network  
Server /cimc/network # set dhcp-enabled yes  
Server /cimc/network *# set v4-addr 10.20.30.11  
Server /cimc/network *# set v4-netmask 255.255.248.0  
Server /cimc/network *# set v4-gateway 10.20.30.1  
Server /cimc/network *# set dns-use-dhcp-enabled no  
Server /cimc/network *# set preferred-dns-server 192.168.30.31  
Server /cimc/network *# set alternate-dns-server 192.168.30.32  
Server /cimc/network *# commit  
Server /cimc/network # show detail  
Network Setting:  
IPv4 Address: 10.20.30.11  
IPv4 Netmask: 255.255.248.0  
IPv4 Gateway: 10.20.30.1  
DHCP Enabled: yes  
Obtain DNS Server by DHCP: no  
Preferred DNS: 192.168.30.31  
Alternate DNS: 192.168.30.32  
VLAN Enabled: no  
VLAN ID: 1  
VLAN Priority: 0  
Hostname: Server  
MAC Address: 01:23:45:67:89:AB  
NIC Mode: dedicated  
NIC Redundancy: none  
Server /cimc/network #  
Configuring the Server VLAN  
Before You Begin  
You must be logged in as admin to configure the server VLAN.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Server /cimc # scope network  
Enters the CIMC network command mode.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Configuring Network-Related Settings  
Connecting to a Port Profile  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 3  
Server /cimc/network # set vlan-enabled Selects whether the CIMC is connected to a  
{yes | no}  
VLAN.  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /cimc/network # set vlan-id id  
Specifies the VLAN number.  
Server /cimc/network # set vlan-priority Specifies the priority of this system on the  
priority  
VLAN.  
Step 6  
Step 7  
Server /cimc/network # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system  
configuration.  
Server /cimc/network # show [detail]  
(Optional) Displays the network settings.  
This example configures the server VLAN:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope network  
Server /cimc/network # set vlan-enabled yes  
Server /cimc/network *# set vlan-id 10  
Server /cimc/network *# set vlan-priority 32  
Server /cimc/network *# commit  
Server /cimc/network # show detail  
Network Setting:  
IPv4 Address: 10.20.30.11  
IPv4 Netmask: 255.255.248.0  
IPv4 Gateway: 10.20.30.1  
DHCP Enabled: yes  
Obtain DNS Server by DHCP: no  
Preferred DNS: 192.168.30.31  
Alternate DNS: 192.168.30.32  
VLAN Enabled: yes  
VLAN ID: 10  
VLAN Priority: 32  
Hostname: Server  
MAC Address: 01:23:45:67:89:AB  
NIC Mode: dedicated  
NIC Redundancy: none  
Server /cimc/network #  
Connecting to a Port Profile  
Note  
You can configure a port profile or a VLAN, but you cannot use both. If you want to use a port profile,  
make sure the set vlan-enabled command is set to no.  
Before You Begin  
You must be logged in as admin to connect to a port profile.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
78  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Configuring Network-Related Settings  
Connecting to a Port Profile  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope network Enters the CIMC network command mode.  
Server /cimc/network # set  
Specifies the port profile CIMC should use to configure the  
port-profile port_profile_name management interface, the virtual Ethernet, and the VIF on  
supported adapter cards such as the Cisco UCS VIC1225  
Virtual Interface Card.  
Enter up to 80 alphanumeric characters. You cannot use  
spaces or other special characters except for - (hyphen) and  
_ (underscore). In addition, the port profile name cannot begin  
with a hyphen.  
Note  
The port profile must be defined on the switch to  
which this server is connected.  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /cimc/network # commit Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
Server /cimc/network # show  
[detail]  
(Optional)  
Displays the network settings.  
This example connects to port profile abcde12345:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope network  
Server /cimc/network # set port-profile abcde12345  
Server /cimc/network *# commit  
Server /cimc/network # show detail  
Network Setting:  
IPv4 Address: 10.193.66.174  
IPv4 Netmask: 255.255.248.0  
IPv4 Gateway: 10.193.64.1  
DHCP Enabled: no  
Obtain DNS Server by DHCP: no  
Preferred DNS: 0.0.0.0  
Alternate DNS: 0.0.0.0  
VLAN Enabled: no  
VLAN ID: 1  
VLAN Priority: 0  
Port Profile: abcde12345  
Hostname: Server  
MAC Address: 50:3D:E5:9D:63:3C  
NIC Mode: dedicated  
NIC Redundancy: none  
Server /cimc/network #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Security Configuration  
Network Security  
The CIMC uses IP blocking as network security. IP blocking prevents the connection between a server or  
website and certain IP addresses or ranges of addresses. IP blocking effectively bans undesired connections  
from those computers to a website, mail server, or other Internet servers.  
IP banning is commonly used to protect against denial of service (DoS) attacks. CIMC bans IP addresses by  
setting up an IP blocking fail count.  
Configuring Network Security  
Configure network security if you want to set up an IP blocking fail count.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to configure network security.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Server /cimc # scope network  
Server /cimc/network # scope  
Enters the CIMC network command mode.  
Enters the IP blocking command mode.  
         
Configuring Network-Related Settings  
Network Time Protocol Configuration  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enter an integer between 300 and 900.  
Step 8  
Server /cimc/network/ipblocking #  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
commit  
This example configures IP blocking:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope network  
Server /cimc/network # scope ipblocking  
Server /cimc/network/ipblocking # set enabled yes  
Server /cimc/network/ipblocking *# set fail-count 5  
Server /cimc/network/ipblocking *# set fail-window 90  
Server /cimc/network/ipblocking *# set penalty-time 600  
Server /cimc/network/ipblocking *# commit  
Server /cimc/network/ipblocking #  
Network Time Protocol Configuration  
Configuring Network Time Protocol Settings  
By default, when CIMC is reset, it synchronizes the time with the host. With the introduction of the NTP  
service, you can configure CIMC to synchronize the time with an NTP server. The NTP server does not run  
in CIMC by default. You must enable and configure the NTP service by specifying the IP/DNS address of at  
least one server or a maximum of four servers that function as NTP servers or time source servers. When you  
enable the NTP service, CIMC synchronizes the time with the configured NTP server. The NTP service can  
be modified only through CIMC.  
Note  
To enable the NTP service, it is preferable to specify the IP address of a server rather than the DNS address.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server # scope cimc  
Enters CIMC command mode.  
Server /cimc # scope network  
Enters network command mode.  
Server /cimc/network # scope ntp  
Enters NTP service command mode.  
Server /cimc/network/ntp # set enabled Enables the NTP service on the server.  
yes  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Configuring Network-Related Settings  
Configuring Network Time Protocol Settings  
Command or Action  
Server /cimc/network/ntp* # commit  
Server /cimc/network/ntp # set server-1 Specifies the IP/DNS address of one of the four  
Purpose  
Step 5  
Step 6  
Commits the transaction.  
10.120.33.44  
servers that act as an NTP server or the time source  
server.  
Step 7  
Step 8  
Step 9  
Step 10  
Server /cimc/network/ntp # set server-2 Specifies the IP/DNS address of one of the four  
10.120.34.45  
servers that act as an NTP server or the time source  
server.  
Server /cimc/network/ntp # set server-3 Specifies the IP/DNS address of one of the four  
10.120.35.46  
servers that act as an NTP server or the time source  
server.  
Server /cimc/network/ntp # set server-4 Specifies the IP/DNS address of one of the four  
10.120.36.48  
servers that act as an NTP server or the time source  
server.  
Server /cimc/network/ntp # commit  
Commits the transaction.  
This example shows how to configure the NTP service:  
Server # scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope network  
Server /cimc/network # scope ntp  
Server /cimc/network/ntp # set enabled yes  
Warning: IPMI Set SEL Time Command will be  
disabled if NTP is enabled.  
Do you wish to continue? [y|N]  
y
Server /cimc/network/ntp* # commit  
Server /cimc/network/ntp # set server-1 10.120.33.44  
Server /cimc/network/ntp* # set server-2 10.120.34.45  
Server /cimc/network/ntp* # set server-3 10.120.35.46  
Server /cimc/network/ntp* # set server-4 10.120.36.48  
Server /cimc/network/ntp* # commit  
Server /cimc/network/ntp #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
82  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
C H A P T E R  
9
Managing Network Adapters  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Overview of the Cisco UCS C-Series Network Adapters  
Note  
The procedures in this chapter are available only when a Cisco UCS C-Series network adapter is installed  
in the chassis.  
A Cisco UCS C-Series network adapter can be installed to provide options for I/O consolidation and  
virtualization support. The following adapters are available:  
Cisco UCS P81E Virtual Interface Card  
Cisco UCS VIC1225 Virtual Interface Card  
•
•
The interactive UCS Hardware and Software Interoperability Utility lets you view the supported components  
and configurations for a selected server model and software release. The utility is available at the following  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Cisco UCS P81E Virtual Interface Card  
The Cisco UCS P81E Virtual Interface Card is optimized for virtualized environments, for organizations that  
seek increased mobility in their physical environments, and for data centers that want reduced costs through  
NIC, HBA, cabling, and switch reduction and reduced management overhead. This Fibre Channel over Ethernet  
(FCoE) PCIe card offers the following benefits:  
Allows up to 16 virtual Fibre Channel and 16 virtual Ethernet adapters to be provisioned in virtualized  
or nonvirtualized environments using just-in-time provisioning, providing tremendous system flexibility  
and allowing consolidation of multiple physical adapters.  
•
Delivers uncompromising virtualization support, including hardware-based implementation of Cisco  
VN-Link technology and pass-through switching.  
•
•
Improves system security and manageability by providing visibility and portability of network polices  
and security all the way to the virtual machine.  
The virtual interface card makes Cisco VN-Link connections to the parent fabric interconnects, which allows  
virtual links to connect virtual NICs in virtual machines to virtual interfaces in the interconnect. In a Cisco  
Unified Computing System environment, virtual links then can be managed, network profiles applied, and  
interfaces dynamically reprovisioned as virtual machines move between servers in the system.  
Cisco UCS VIC1225 Virtual Interface Card  
The Cisco UCS VIC1225 Virtual Interface Card is a high-performance, converged network adapter that  
provides acceleration for the various new operational modes introduced by server virtualization. It brings  
superior flexibility, performance, and bandwidth to the new generation of Cisco UCS C-Series Rack-Mount  
Servers.  
The Cisco UCS VIC 1225 implements the Cisco Virtual Machine Fabric Extender (VM-FEX), which unifies  
virtual and physical networking into a single infrastructure. It provides virtual-machine visibility from the  
physical network and a consistent network operations model for physical and virtual servers.  
Managing Network Adapters  
Viewing Network Adapter Properties  
Viewing Network Adapter Properties  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show adapter  
[index] [detail]  
Displays adapter properties. To display the properties  
of a single adapter, specify the PCI slot number as the  
index argument.  
This example displays the properties of adapter 2:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show adapter  
PCI Slot Product Name  
Serial Number Product ID  
Vendor  
-------- -------------- -------------- -------------- --------------------  
UCS VIC 1225 FCH1613796C UCSC-PCIE-C... Cisco Systems Inc  
1
Server /chassis # show adapter 2 detail  
PCI Slot 2:  
Product Name: UCS VIC 1225  
Serial Number: FCH1613796C  
Product ID: UCSC-PCIE-CSC-02  
Adapter Hardware Revision: 4  
Current FW Version: 2.1(0.291)  
NIV: Disabled  
FIP: Enabled  
Configuration Pending: no  
CIMC Management Enabled : no  
VID: V00  
Vendor: Cisco Systems Inc  
Description:  
Bootloader Version: 2.1(0.291)  
FW Image 1 Version: 2.1(0.291)  
FW Image 1 State: RUNNING ACTIVATED  
FW Image 2 Version: 1.6(0.547)  
FW Image 2 State: BACKUP INACTIVATED  
FW Update Status: Idle  
FW Update Error: No error  
FW Update Stage: No operation (0%)  
FW Update Overall Progress: 0%  
Server /chassis #  
Configuring Network Adapter Properties  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
•
•
A supported Virtual Interface Card (VIC) must be installed in the chassis and the server must be powered  
on.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Managing Network Adapters  
Managing vHBAs  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show adapter (Optional) Displays the available adapter devices.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the PCI  
index  
slot number specified by index.  
The server must be powered on before you can view  
or change adapter settings.  
Note  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /chassis/adapter # set  
fip-mode {disable | enable}  
Enables or disables FCoE Initialization Protocol (FIP) on  
the adapter card. FIP is enabled by default.  
Note  
We recommend that you disable this option only  
when explicitly directed to do so by a technical  
support representative.  
Server /chassis/adapter # set  
niv-mode {disable | enable}  
Enables or disables Network Interface Virtualization (NIV)  
on the adapter card. NIV is disabled by default.  
If NIV mode is enabled, vNICs:  
Can be assigned to a specific channel  
Can be associated with a port profile  
•
•
•
Can fail over to another vNIC if there are  
communication problems  
Step 6  
Step 7  
Server /chassis/adapter #  
configure-vmfex port-count  
If NIV mode is enabled, port-count specifies the number of  
VM FEX interfaces you want CIMC to create, from 0 to 112.  
Server /chassis/adapter # commit Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
This example configures the properties of adapter 1:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # set fip-mode enable  
Server /chassis/adapter *# commit  
Server /chassis/adapter #  
Managing vHBAs  
Guidelines for Managing vHBAs  
When managing vHBAs, consider the following guidelines and restrictions:  
The Cisco UCS P81E Virtual Interface Card and Cisco UCS VIC1225 Virtual Interface Card provide  
two vHBAs (fc0 and fc1). You can create up to 16 additional vHBAs on these adapter cards.  
•
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
86  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Managing Network Adapters  
Viewing vHBA Properties  
Note  
If Network Interface Virtualization (NIV) mode is enabled for the adapter, you must  
assign a channel number to a vHBA when you create it.  
When using the Cisco UCS P81E Virtual Interface Card or Cisco UCS VIC1225 Virtual Interface Card  
in an FCoE application, you must associate the vHBA with the FCoE VLAN. Follow the instructions  
in to assign the VLAN.  
•
•
After making configuration changes, you must reboot the host for settings to take effect.  
Viewing vHBA Properties  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Server# scope chassis  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter index Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the  
PCI slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you  
can view or change adapter settings.  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/adapter # show  
host-fc-if [fc0 | fc1 | name] [detail]  
Displays properties of a single vHBA, if specified, or  
all vHBAs.  
This example displays all vHBAs on adapter card 1 and the detailed properties of fc0:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # show host-fc-if  
Name  
World Wide Port Name  
FC SAN Boot Uplink Port  
-------- ------------------------ ----------- -----------  
fc0  
fc1  
20:00:00:22:BD:D6:5C:35 Disabled  
20:00:00:22:BD:D6:5C:36 Disabled  
0
1
Server /chassis/adapter # show host-fc-if fc0 detail  
Name fc0:  
World Wide Node Name: 10:00:00:22:BD:D6:5C:35  
World Wide Port Name: 20:00:00:22:BD:D6:5C:35  
FC SAN Boot: Disabled  
Persistent LUN Binding: Disabled  
Uplink Port: 0  
MAC Address: 00:22:BD:D6:5C:35  
CoS: 3  
VLAN: NONE  
Rate Limiting: OFF  
PCIe Device Order: ANY  
EDTOV: 2000  
RATOV: 10000  
Maximum Data Field Size: 2112  
Channel Number: 3  
Port Profile:  
Server /chassis/adapter #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Modifying vHBA Properties  
Modifying vHBA Properties  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # show adapter  
(Optional) Displays the available adapter devices.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter index Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the  
PCI slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you  
can view or change adapter settings.  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope host-fc-if Enters the host Fibre Channel interface command  
{fc0 | fc1 | name}  
mode for the specified vHBA.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # set Specifies a unique World Wide Node Name (WWNN)  
wwnn wwnn  
for the adapter in the form hh:hh:hh:hh:hh:hh:hh:hh.  
Unless specified by this command, the WWNN is  
generated automatically by the system.  
Step 6  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # set Specifies a unique World Wide Port Name (WWPN)  
wwpn wwpn  
for the adapter in the form hh:hh:hh:hh:hh:hh:hh:hh.  
Unless specified by this command, the WWPN is  
generated automatically by the system.  
Step 7  
Step 8  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # set Enables or disables FC SAN boot. The default is  
boot {disable | enable}  
disable.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # set Enables or disables persistent LUN binding. The  
persistent-lun-binding {disable |  
enable}  
default is disable.  
Step 9  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # set Specifies a MAC address for the vHBA.  
mac-addr mac-addr  
Step 10  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # set Specifies the default VLAN for this vHBA. Valid  
vlan {none | vlan-id}  
VLAN numbers are 1 to 4094; the default is none.  
Step 11  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # set Specifies the class of service (CoS) value to be marked  
cos cos-value  
on received packets unless the vHBA is configured  
to trust host CoS. Valid CoS values are 0 to 6; the  
default is 0. Higher values indicate more important  
traffic.  
This setting is not functional in NIV mode.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
88  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Modifying vHBA Properties  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 12  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # set Specifies a maximum data rate for the vHBA. The  
rate-limit {off | rate}  
range is 1 to 10000 Mbps; the default is off.  
This setting is not functional in NIV mode.  
Step 13  
Step 14  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # set Specifies the relative order of this device for PCIe bus  
order {any | 0-99}  
device number assignment; the default is any.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # set Specifies the error detect timeout value (EDTOV),  
error-detect-timeout msec  
the number of milliseconds to wait before the system  
assumes that an error has occurred. The range is 1000  
to 100000; the default is 2000 milliseconds.  
Step 15  
Step 16  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # set Specifies the resource allocation timeout value  
resource-allocation-timeout msec  
(RATOV), the number of milliseconds to wait before  
the system assumes that a resource cannot be properly  
allocated. The range is 5000 to 100000; the default is  
10000 milliseconds.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # set Specifies the maximum size of the Fibre Channel  
max-field-size size  
frame payload (in bytes) that the vHBA supports. The  
range is 1 to 2112; the default is 2112 bytes.  
Step 17  
Step 18  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # scope Enters the Fibre Channel error recovery command  
error-recovery  
mode.  
Server  
Enables or disables FCP Error Recovery. The default  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/error-recovery is disable.  
# set fcp-error-recovery {disable |  
enable}  
Step 19  
Step 20  
Step 21  
Step 22  
Server  
Specifies the link down timeout value, the number of  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/error-recovery milliseconds the uplink port should be offline before  
# set link-down-timeout msec  
it informs the system that the uplink port is down and  
fabric connectivity has been lost. The range is 0 to  
240000; the default is 30000 milliseconds.  
Server  
Specifies the port down I/O retries value, the number  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/error-recovery of times an I/O request to a port is returned because  
# set port-down-io-retry-count count the port is busy before the system decides the port is  
unavailable. The range is 0 to 255; the default is 8  
retries.  
Server  
Specifies the port down timeout value, the number of  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/error-recovery milliseconds a remote Fibre Channel port should be  
# set port-down-timeout msec  
offline before informing the SCSI upper layer that the  
port is unavailable. The range is 0 to 240000; the  
default is 10000 milliseconds.  
Server  
Exits to the host Fibre Channel interface command  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/error-recovery mode.  
# exit  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing Network Adapters  
Modifying vHBA Properties  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 23  
Step 24  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # scope Enters the interrupt command mode.  
interrupt  
Server  
Specifies the Fibre Channel interrupt mode. The  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/interrupt # set modes are as follows:  
interrupt-mode {intx | msi | msix}  
• intx —Line-based interrupt (INTx)  
• msi —Message-Signaled Interrupt (MSI)  
• msix —Message Signaled Interrupts with the  
optional extension (MSIx). This is the  
recommended and default option.  
Step 25  
Server  
Exits to the host Fibre Channel interface command  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/interrupt # exit mode.  
Step 26  
Step 27  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # scope Enters the Fibre Channel port command mode.  
port  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/port # Specifies the I/O throttle count, the number of I/O  
set outstanding-io-count count  
operations that can be pending in the vHBA at one  
time. The range is 1 to 1024; the default is 512  
operations.  
Step 28  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/port # Specifies the maximum logical unit numbers (LUNs)  
set max-target-luns count  
per target, the maximum number of LUNs that the  
driver will discover. This is usually an operating  
system platform limitation. The range is 1 to 1024;  
the default is 256 LUNs.  
Step 29  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/port # Exits to the host Fibre Channel interface command  
exit mode.  
Step 30  
Step 31  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # scope Enters the Fibre Channel fabric login command mode.  
port-f-logi  
Server  
Specifies the fabric login (FLOGI) retries value, the  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/port-f-logi # number of times that the system tries to log in to the  
set flogi-retries {infinite | count}  
fabric after the first failure. Enter a number between  
0 and 4294967295 or enter infinite ; the default is  
infinite retries.  
Step 32  
Step 33  
Server  
Specifies the fabric login (FLOGI) timeout value, the  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/port-f-logi # number of milliseconds that the system waits before  
set flogi-timeout msec  
it tries to log in again. The range is 1 to 255000; the  
default is 2000 milliseconds.  
Server  
Exits to the host Fibre Channel interface command  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/port-f-logi # mode.  
exit  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
90  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing Network Adapters  
Modifying vHBA Properties  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 34  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # scope Enters the Fibre Channel port login command mode.  
port-p-logi  
Step 35  
Step 36  
Step 37  
Server  
Specifies the port login (PLOGI) retries value, the  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/port-p-logi # number of times that the system tries to log in to the  
set plogi-retries count  
fabric after the first failure. The range is 0 and 255;  
the default is 8 retries.  
Server  
Specifies the port login (PLOGI) timeout value, the  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/port-p-logi # number of milliseconds that the system waits before  
set plogi-timeout msec  
it tries to log in again. The range is 1 to 255000; the  
default is 2000 milliseconds.  
Server  
Exits to the host Fibre Channel interface command  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/port-p-logi # mode.  
exit  
Step 38  
Step 39  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # scope Enters the SCSI I/O command mode.  
scsi-io  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/scsi-io The number of command descriptor block (CDB)  
# set cdb-wq-count count  
transmit queue resources to allocate. The range is 1  
to 8; the default is 1.  
Step 40  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/scsi-io The number of descriptors in the command descriptor  
# set cdb-wq-ring-size size  
block (CDB) transmit queue. The range is 64 to 512;  
the default is 512.  
Step 41  
Step 42  
Step 43  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/scsi-io Exits to the host Fibre Channel interface command  
# exit mode.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # scope Enters the Fibre Channel transmit queue command  
trans-queue  
mode.  
Server  
The number of descriptors in the Fibre Channel  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/trans-queue # transmit queue. The range is 64 to 128; the default is  
set fc-wq-ring-size size  
64.  
Step 44  
Server  
Exits to the host Fibre Channel interface command  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/trans-queue # mode.  
exit  
Step 45  
Step 46  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # scope Enters the Fibre Channel receive queue command  
recv-queue  
mode.  
Server  
The number of descriptors in the Fibre Channel  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/recv-queue # receive queue. The range is 64 to 128; the default is  
set fc-rq-ring-size size  
64.  
Step 47  
Server  
Exits to the host Fibre Channel interface command  
/chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/recv-queue # mode.  
exit  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing Network Adapters  
Creating a vHBA  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
Step 48  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if #  
commit  
Note  
The changes will take effect upon the next  
server reboot.  
This example configures the properties of a vHBA:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show adapter  
PCI Slot Product Name  
Serial Number Product ID  
Vendor  
-------- -------------- -------------- -------------- --------------------  
1
UCS VIC P81E  
QCI1417A0QK  
N2XX-ACPCI01  
Cisco Systems Inc  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope host-fc-if fc1  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # set boot enable  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if *# scope scsi-io  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/scsi-io *# set cdb-wq-count 2  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/scsi-io *# exit  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if *# commit  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if #  
What to Do Next  
Reboot the server to apply the changes.  
Creating a vHBA  
The adapter provides two permanent vHBAs. If NIV mode is enabled, you can create up to 16 additional  
vHBAs.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with user or admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter  
Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the PCI  
index  
slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you can  
view or change adapter settings.  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/adapter # create  
host-fc-if name  
Creates a vHBA and enters the host Fibre Channel  
interface command mode. The name argument can be up  
to 32 ASCII characters.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
92  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Deleting a vHBA  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # (Optional)  
set channel-number number  
If NIV mode is enabled for the adapter, you must assign  
a channel number to this vHBA. The range is 1 to 1000.  
Step 5  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
commit  
Note  
The changes will take effect upon the next server  
reboot.  
This example creates a vHBA on adapter 1:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # create host-fc-if Vhba5  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if *# commit  
New host-fc-if settings will take effect upon the next server reset  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if #  
What to Do Next  
Reboot the server to create the vHBA.  
•
•
If configuration changes are required, configure the new vHBA as described in Modifying vHBA  
Properties, on page 88.  
Deleting a vHBA  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the PCI  
index  
slot number specified by index.  
The server must be powered on before you can  
view or change adapter settings.  
Deletes the specified vHBA.  
You cannot delete either of the two default  
vHBAs, fc0 or fc1.  
Server /chassis/adapter # commit Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
Note  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/adapter # delete  
host-fc-if name  
Note  
Note  
The changes will take effect upon the next server  
reboot.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
vHBA Boot Table  
This example deletes a vHBA on adapter 1:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # delete host-fc-if Vhba5  
Server /chassis/adapter *# commit  
Server /chassis/adapter #  
vHBA Boot Table  
In the vHBA boot table, you can specify up to four LUNs from which the server can boot.  
Viewing the Boot Table  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Server# scope chassis  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server /chassis # scope adapter index Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the  
PCI slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you  
can view or change adapter settings.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope  
host-fc-if {fc0 | fc1 | name}  
Enters the host Fibre Channel interface command mode  
for the specified vHBA.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if #  
Displays the boot table of the Fibre Channel interface.  
show boot  
This example displays the boot table for a vHBA:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope host-fc-if fc1  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # show boot  
Boot Table Entry Boot Target WWPN  
Boot LUN ID  
----------------- -------------------------- ------------  
0
1
20:00:00:11:22:33:44:55  
20:00:00:11:22:33:44:56  
3
5
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if #  
Creating a Boot Table Entry  
You can create up to four boot table entries.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
94  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Managing Network Adapters  
Deleting a Boot Table Entry  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter  
Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the PCI  
index  
slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you can  
view or change adapter settings.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope  
host-fc-if {fc0 | fc1 | name}  
Enters the host Fibre Channel interface command mode  
for the specified vHBA.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # Creates a boot table entry.  
create-boot-entry wwpn lun-id  
• wwpn — The World Wide Port Name (WWPN) for  
the boot target in the form hh:hh:hh:hh:hh:hh:hh:hh.  
• lun-id —The LUN ID of the boot LUN. The range  
is 0 to 255.  
Step 5  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
commit  
Note  
The changes will take effect upon the next server  
reboot.  
This example creates a boot table entry for vHBA fc1:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope host-fc-if fc1  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # create-boot-entry 20:00:00:11:22:33:44:55 3  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if *# commit  
New boot table entry will take effect upon the next server reset  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if #  
Deleting a Boot Table Entry  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter  
Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the PCI  
index  
slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you can  
view or change adapter settings.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OL-28893-01  
95  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
vHBA Persistent Binding  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope  
host-fc-if {fc0 | fc1 | name}  
Enters the host Fibre Channel interface command mode  
for the specified vHBA.  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # Displays the boot table. From the Boot Table Entry field,  
show boot locate the number of the entry to be deleted.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # Deletes the boot table entry at the specified position in  
delete boot entry  
the table. The range of entry is 0 to 3. The change will  
take effect upon the next server reset.  
Step 6  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
commit  
Note  
The changes will take effect upon the next server  
reboot.  
This example deletes boot table entry number 1 for the vHBA fc1:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope host-fc-if fc1  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # show boot  
Boot Table Entry Boot Target WWPN  
Boot LUN ID  
----------------- -------------------------- ------------  
0
1
20:00:00:11:22:33:44:55  
20:00:00:11:22:33:44:56  
3
5
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # delete boot 1  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if *# commit  
New host-fc-if settings will take effect upon the next server reset  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # show boot  
Boot Table Entry Boot Target WWPN  
----------------- -------------------------- ------------  
20:00:00:11:22:33:44:55  
Boot LUN ID  
0
3
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if #  
What to Do Next  
Reboot the server to apply the changes.  
vHBA Persistent Binding  
Persistent binding ensures that the system-assigned mapping of Fibre Channel targets is maintained after a  
reboot.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
96  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Enabling Persistent Binding  
Enabling Persistent Binding  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter index  
Enters the command mode for the adapter card at  
the PCI slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you  
can view or change adapter settings.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope host-fc-if Enters the host Fibre Channel interface command  
{fc0 | fc1 | name}  
mode for the specified vHBA.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # scope Enters the persistent binding command mode for  
perbi  
the vHBA.  
Step 5  
Step 6  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/perbi # Enables persistent binding for the vHBA.  
set persistent-lun-binding enable  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/perbi # Commits the transaction to the system  
commit  
configuration.  
This example enables persistent binding for a vHBA:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 4  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope host-fc-if fc1  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # scope perbi  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/perbi # set persistent-lun-binding enable  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/perbi *# commit  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/perbi #  
Disabling Persistent Binding  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter index  
Enters the command mode for the adapter card at  
the PCI slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you  
can view or change adapter settings.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OL-28893-01  
97  
       
Managing Network Adapters  
Rebuilding Persistent Binding  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope host-fc-if Enters the host Fibre Channel interface command  
{fc0 | fc1 | name}  
mode for the specified vHBA.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # scope Enters the persistent binding command mode for  
perbi  
the vHBA.  
Step 5  
Step 6  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/perbi # Disables persistent binding for the vHBA.  
set persistent-lun-binding disable  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/perbi # Commits the transaction to the system  
commit  
configuration.  
This example disables persistent binding for a vHBA:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 4  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope host-fc-if fc1  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # scope perbi  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/perbi # set persistent-lun-binding disable  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/perbi *# commit  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/perbi #  
Rebuilding Persistent Binding  
Before You Begin  
Persistent binding must be enabled in the vHBA properties.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter index Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the  
PCI slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you  
can view or change adapter settings.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope  
host-fc-if {fc0 | fc1 | name}  
Enters the host Fibre Channel interface command  
mode for the specified vHBA.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if #  
scope perbi  
Enters the persistent binding command mode for the  
vHBA.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/perbi Rebuilds the persistent binding table for the vHBA.  
# rebuild  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
98  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Managing vNICs  
This example rebuilds the persistent binding table for a vHBA:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 4  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope host-fc-if fc1  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if # scope perbi  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/perbi # rebuild  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-fc-if/perbi #  
Managing vNICs  
Guidelines for Managing vNICs  
When managing vNICs, consider the following guidelines and restrictions:  
The Cisco UCS P81E Virtual Interface Card and Cisco UCS VIC1225 Virtual Interface Card provide  
two default vNICs (eth0 and eth1). You can create up to 16 additional vNICs on these adapter cards.  
•
Note  
If Network Interface Virtualization (NIV) mode is enabled for the adapter, you must  
assign a channel number to a vNIC when you create it.  
After making configuration changes, you must reboot the host for settings to take effect.  
•
Viewing vNIC Properties  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Server# scope chassis  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter index Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the  
PCI slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you  
can view or change adapter settings.  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/adapter # show  
Displays properties of a single vNIC, if specified, or  
host-eth-if [eth0 | eth1 | name] [detail] all vNICs.  
This example displays the brief properties of all vNICs and the detailed properties of eth0:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # show host-eth-if  
Name  
MTU Uplink Port MAC Address  
CoS VLAN PXE Boot  
-------- ---- ----------- ----------------- --- ---- --------  
eth0  
eth1  
1500 0  
1500 1  
00:22:BD:D6:5C:33 0  
00:22:BD:D6:5C:34 0  
NONE Enabled  
NONE Enabled  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Managing Network Adapters  
Modifying vNIC Properties  
Server /chassis/adapter # show host-eth-if eth0 detail  
Name eth0:  
MTU: 1500  
Uplink Port: 0  
MAC Address: 00:22:BD:D6:5C:33  
CoS: 0  
Trust Host CoS: disabled  
PCI Order: ANY  
VLAN: NONE  
VLAN Mode: TRUNK  
Rate Limiting: OFF  
PXE Boot: enabled  
Channel Number: N/A  
Port Profile: N/A  
Uplink Failover: N/A  
Uplink Failback Timeout: N/A  
Server /chassis/adapter #  
Modifying vNIC Properties  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
(Optional) Displays the available adapter devices.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show adapter  
Server /chassis # scope adapter index Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the  
PCI slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you can  
view or change adapter settings.  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope  
host-eth-if {eth0 | eth1 | name}  
Enters the host Ethernet interface command mode for  
the specified vNIC.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set Specifies the maximum transmission unit (MTU) or  
mtu mtu-value  
packet size that the vNIC accepts. Valid MTU values  
are 1500 to 9000 bytes; the default is 1500.  
Step 6  
Step 7  
Step 8  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set Specifies the uplink port associated with this vNIC. All  
uplink {0 | 1}  
traffic for this vNIC goes through this uplink port.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set Specifies a MAC address for the vNIC in the form  
mac-addr mac-addr  
hh:hh:hh:hh:hh:hh or hhhh:hhhh:hhhh.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set Specifies the class of service (CoS) value to be marked  
cos cos-value  
on received packets unless the vNIC is configured to  
trust host CoS. Valid CoS values are 0 to 6; the default  
is 0. Higher values indicate more important traffic.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
100  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Modifying vNIC Properties  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Note  
If NIV is enabled, this setting is determined  
by the switch, and the command is ignored.  
Step 9  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set Specifies whether the vNIC will trust host CoS or will  
trust-host-cos {disable | enable}  
remark packets. The behavior is as follows:  
• disable —Received packets are remarked with  
the configured CoS. This is the default.  
• enable —The existing CoS value of received  
packets (host CoS) is preserved.  
Step 10  
Step 11  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set Specifies the relative order of this device for PCI bus  
order {any | 0-99}  
device number assignment; the default is any.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set Specifies the default VLAN for this vNIC. Valid VLAN  
vlan {none | vlan-id}  
numbers are 1 to 4094; the default is none.  
Note  
If NIV is enabled, this setting is determined  
by the switch, and the command is ignored.  
Step 12  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set Specifies the VLAN mode for the vNIC. The modes  
vlan-mode {access | trunk}  
are as follows:  
• access —The vNIC belongs to only one VLAN.  
• trunk —The vNIC can belong to more than one  
VLAN. This is the default.  
Note  
If NIV is enabled, this setting is determined  
by the switch, and the command is ignored.  
Step 13  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set Specifies a maximum data rate for the vNIC. The range  
rate-limit {off | rate}  
is 1 to 10000 Mbps; the default is off.  
Note  
If NIV is enabled, this setting is determined  
by the switch, and the command is ignored.  
Step 14  
Step 15  
Step 16  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set Specifies whether the vNIC can be used to perform a  
boot {disable | enable}  
PXE boot. The default is enable for the two default  
vNICs, and disable for user-created vNICs.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set If NIV mode is enabled for the adapter, select the  
channel-number number  
channel number that will be assigned to this vNIC. The  
range is 1 to 1000.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set If NIV mode is enabled for the adapter, select the port  
port-profile name  
profile that should be associated with the vNIC.  
Note  
The name must be a port profile defined on  
the switch to which this server is connected.  
Step 17  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set If NIV mode is enabled for the adapter, enable this  
uplink-failover {disable | enable}  
setting if traffic on this vNIC should fail over to the  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing Network Adapters  
Modifying vNIC Properties  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
secondary interface if there are communication  
problems.  
Step 18  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set After a vNIC has started using its secondary interface,  
uplink-failback-timeout seconds  
this setting controls how long the primary interface  
must be available before the system resumes using the  
primary interface for the vNIC.  
Enter a number of seconds between 0 and 600.  
Step 19  
Step 20  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if #  
scope interrupt  
Enters the interrupt command mode.  
Server  
Specifies the number of interrupt resources. The range  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/interrupt # is 1 to 514; the default is 8. In general, you should  
set interrupt-count count  
allocate one interrupt resource for each completion  
queue.  
Step 21  
Step 22  
Server  
The time to wait between interrupts or the idle period  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/interrupt # that must be encountered before an interrupt is sent.  
set coalescing-time usec  
The range is 1 to 65535 microseconds; the default is  
125. To turn off coalescing, enter 0 (zero).  
Server  
The coalescing types are as follows:  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/interrupt #  
set coalescing-type {idle | min}  
• idle —The system does not send an interrupt until  
there is a period of no activity lasting as least as  
long as the time specified in the coalescing time  
configuration.  
• min —The system waits for the time specified in  
the coalescing time configuration before sending  
another interrupt event. This is the default.  
Step 23  
Server  
Specifies the Ethernet interrupt mode. The modes are  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/interrupt # as follows:  
set interrupt-mode {intx | msi | msix}  
• intx —Line-based interrupt (PCI INTx)  
• msi —Message-Signaled Interrupt (MSI)  
• msix —Message Signaled Interrupts with the  
optional extension (MSI-X). This is the  
recommended and default option.  
Step 24  
Step 25  
Server  
Exits to the host Ethernet interface command mode.  
Enters receive queue command mode.  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/interrupt #  
exit  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if #  
scope recv-queue  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
102  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing Network Adapters  
Modifying vNIC Properties  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
The number of receive queue resources to allocate. The  
Step 26  
Server  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/recv-queue range is 1 to 256; the default is 4.  
# set rq-count count  
Step 27  
Step 28  
Server  
The number of descriptors in the receive queue. The  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/recv-queue range is 64 to 4094; the default is 512.  
# set rq-ring-size size  
Server  
Exits to the host Ethernet interface command mode.  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/recv-queue  
# exit  
Step 29  
Step 30  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if #  
scope trans-queue  
Enters transmit queue command mode.  
Server  
The number of transmit queue resources to allocate.  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/trans-queue The range is 1 to 256; the default is 1.  
# set wq-count count  
Step 31  
Step 32  
Server  
The number of descriptors in the transmit queue. The  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/trans-queue range is 64 to 4094; the default is 256.  
# set wq-ring-size size  
Server  
Exits to the host Ethernet interface command mode.  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/trans-queue  
# exit  
Step 33  
Step 34  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if #  
scope comp-queue  
Enters completion queue command mode.  
Server  
The number of completion queue resources to allocate.  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/comp-queue The range is 1 to 512; the default is 5.  
# set cq-count count  
In general, the number of completion queues equals the  
number of transmit queues plus the number of receive  
queues.  
Step 35  
Server  
Exits to the host Ethernet interface command mode.  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/comp-queue  
# exit  
Step 36  
Step 37  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if #  
scope offload  
Enters TCP offload command mode.  
Server  
Enables or disables TCP Segmentation Offload as  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/offload # follows:  
set tcp-segment-offload {disable |  
enable}  
• disable —The CPU segments large TCP packets.  
• enable —The CPU sends large TCP packets to  
the hardware to be segmented. This option may  
reduce CPU overhead and increase throughput  
rate. This is the default.  
Note  
This option is also known as Large Send  
Offload (LSO).  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing Network Adapters  
Modifying vNIC Properties  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enables or disables TCP Receive Offload Checksum  
Step 38  
Server  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/offload # Validation as follows:  
set tcp-rx-checksum-offload {disable  
| enable}  
• disable —The CPU validates all packet  
checksums.  
• enable —The CPU sends all packet checksums  
to the hardware for validation. This option may  
reduce CPU overhead. This is the default.  
Step 39  
Step 40  
Step 41  
Server  
Enables or disables TCP Transmit Offload Checksum  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/offload # Validation as follows:  
set tcp-tx-checksum-offload {disable  
| enable}  
• disable —The CPU validates all packet  
checksums.  
• enable —The CPU sends all packet checksums  
to the hardware for validation. This option may  
reduce CPU overhead. This is the default.  
Server  
Enables or disables TCP Large Packet Receive Offload  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/offload # as follows:  
set tcp-large-receive-offload {disable  
| enable}  
• disable —The CPU processes all large packets.  
• enable —The hardware reassembles all segmented  
packets before sending them to the CPU. This  
option may reduce CPU utilization and increase  
inbound throughput. This is the default.  
Server  
Exits to the host Ethernet interface command mode.  
Enters Receive-side Scaling (RSS) command mode.  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/offload #  
exit  
Step 42  
Step 43  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if #  
scope rss  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/rss # Enables or disables RSS, which allows the efficient  
set rss {disable | enable}  
distribution of network receive processing across  
multiple CPUs in multiprocessor systems. The default  
is enable for the two default vNICs, and disable for  
user-created vNICs.  
Step 44  
Step 45  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/rss # Enables or disables IPv4 RSS. The default is enable.  
set rss-hash-ipv4 {disable | enable}  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/rss # Enables or disables TCP/IPv4 RSS. The default is  
set rss-hash-tcp-ipv4 {disable |  
enable}  
enable.  
Step 46  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/rss # Enables or disables IPv6 RSS. The default is enable.  
set rss-hash-ipv6 {disable | enable}  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
104  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing Network Adapters  
Creating a vNIC  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 47  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/rss # Enables or disables TCP/IPv6 RSS. The default is  
set rss-hash-tcp-ipv6 {disable |  
enable}  
enable.  
Step 48  
Step 49  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/rss # Enables or disables IPv6 Extension RSS. The default  
set rss-hash-ipv6-ex {disable | enable} is disable.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/rss # Enables or disables TCP/IPv6 Extension RSS. The  
set rss-hash-tcp-ipv6-ex {disable |  
enable}  
default is disable.  
Step 50  
Step 51  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/rss # Exits to the host Ethernet interface command mode.  
exit  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if #  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
commit  
Note  
The changes will take effect upon the next  
server reboot.  
This example configures the properties of a vNIC:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # show adapter  
PCI Slot Product Name  
Serial Number Product ID  
Vendor  
-------- -------------- -------------- -------------- --------------------  
1
UCS VIC P81E  
QCI1417A0QK  
N2XX-ACPCI01  
Cisco Systems Inc  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope host-eth-if Test1  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # set uplink 1  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if *# scope offload  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/offload *# set tcp-segment-offload enable  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/offload *# exit  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if *# commit  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if #  
What to Do Next  
Reboot the server to apply the changes.  
Creating a vNIC  
The adapter provides two permanent vNICs. You can create up to 16 additional vNICs.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with user or admin privileges to perform this task.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Deleting a vNIC  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter  
Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the PCI  
index  
slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you can  
view or change adapter settings.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /chassis/adapter # create  
host-eth-if name  
Creates a vNIC and enters the host Ethernet interface  
command mode. The name argument can be up to 32  
ASCII characters.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # (Optional)  
set channel-number number If NIV mode is enabled for the adapter, you must assign  
a channel number to this vNIC. The range is 1 to 1000.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
commit  
Note  
The changes will take effect upon the next server  
reboot.  
This example creates a vNIC on adapter 1:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # create host-eth-if Vnic5  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if *# commit  
New host-eth-if settings will take effect upon the next server reset  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if #  
Deleting a vNIC  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the PCI  
index  
slot number specified by index.  
The server must be powered on before you can  
view or change adapter settings.  
Deletes the specified vNIC.  
You cannot delete either of the two default vNICs,  
eth0 or eth1.  
Server /chassis/adapter # commit Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
Note  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/adapter # delete  
host-eth-if name  
Note  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
106  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Configuring iSCSI Boot Capability  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Note  
The changes will take effect upon the next server  
reboot.  
This example deletes a vNIC on adapter 1:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # delete host-eth-if Vnic5  
Server /chassis/adapter *# commit  
Server /chassis/adapter #  
Configuring iSCSI Boot Capability  
Configuring iSCSI Boot Capability for vNICs  
When the rack-servers are configured in a standalone mode, and when the VIC adapters are directly attached  
to the Nexus 5000 family of switches, you can configure these VIC adapters to boot the servers remotely from  
iSCSI storage targets. You can configure Ethernet vNICs to enable a rack server to load the host OS image  
from remote iSCSI target devices.  
To configure the iSCSI boot capability on a vNIC:  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
•
•
To configure a vNIC to boot a server remotely from an iSCSI storage target, you must enable the PXE  
boot option on the vNIC.  
Note  
You can configure a maximum of 2 iSCSI vNICs for each host.  
Configuring iSCSI Boot Capability on a vNIC  
You can configure a maximum of 2 iSCSI vNICs for each host.  
Before You Begin  
To configure a vNIC to boot a server remotely from an iSCSI storage target, you must enable the PXE  
boot option on the vNIC.  
•
•
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Managing Network Adapters  
Configuring iSCSI Boot Capability  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter index  
Enters the command mode for the adapter card at  
the PCI slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before  
you can view or change adapter settings.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope host-eth-if Enters the host Ethernet interface command mode  
{eth0 | eth1 | name}  
for the specified vNIC.  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # create Creates the iSCSI boot index for the vNIC. At this  
iscsi-boot index  
moment, only 0 is allowed as the index.  
Server  
Creates an iSCSI target for the vNIC. The value  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/iscsi-boot* # can either be 0 or 1.  
create iscsi-target index  
Step 6  
Step 7  
Step 8  
Step 9  
Server  
Enables the DHCP network settings for the iSCSI  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/iscsi-boot* # set boot.  
dhcp-net-settings enabled  
Server  
Sets the initiator name. It cannot be more than 223  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/iscsi-boot* # set characters.  
initiator-name string  
Server  
Enables the DHCP iSCSI settings.  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/iscsi-boot* # set  
dhcp-iscsi-settings enabled  
Server  
Commits the transaction to the system  
/chassis/adapter/host-eth-if/iscsi-boot* # configuration.  
commit  
Note  
The changes will take effect upon the  
next server reboot.  
This example shows how to configure the iSCSI boot capability for a vNIC:  
Server # scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope host-eth-if eth0  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # create iscsi-boot 0  
Server /adapter/host-eth-if/iscsi-boot *# set dhcp-net-settings enabled  
Server /adapter/host-eth-if/iscsi-boot *# set initiator-name iqn.2012-01.com.adser:abcde  
Server /adapter/host-eth-if/iscsi-boot *# set dhcp-iscsi-settings enabled  
Server /adapter/host-eth-if/iscsi-boot *# commit  
New host-eth-if settings will take effect upon the next server reset  
Server /adapter/host-eth-if/iscsi-boot #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
108  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing Network Adapters  
Managing VM FEX  
Deleting an iSCSI Boot Configuration for a vNIC  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter index Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the  
PCI slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you  
can view or change adapter settings.  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope  
host-eth-if {eth0 | eth1 | name}  
Enters the host Ethernet interface command mode for  
the specified vNIC.  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # Deletes the iSCSI boot capability for the vNIC.  
delete iscsi-boot 0  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if* # Commits the transaction to the system configuration  
commit  
Note  
The changes will take effect upon the next  
server reboot.  
This example shows how to delete the iSCSI boot capability for a vNIC:  
Server # scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope host-eth-if eth0  
Server /chassis/adapter/host-eth-if # delete iscsi-boot 0  
Server /adapter/host-eth-if/iscsi-boot *# commit  
New host-eth-if settings will take effect upon the next server reset  
Server /adapter/host-eth-if/iscsi-boot #  
Managing VM FEX  
Virtual Machine Fabric Extender  
Cisco Virtual Machine Fabric Extender (VM FEX) extends the (prestandard) IEEE 802.1Qbh port extender  
architecture to virtual machines. In this architecture, each VM interface is provided with a virtual Peripheral  
Component Interconnect Express (PCIe) device and a virtual port on a switch.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Managing Network Adapters  
Viewing VM FEX Properties  
Viewing VM FEX Properties  
Before You Begin  
The server must be powered on, or the properties will not display.  
•
•
A supported Virtual Interface Card (VIC) must be installed in the chassis and the server must be powered  
on.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter index Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the  
PCI slot number specified by index.  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you can  
view or change adapter settings.  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/adapter # show vmfex Displays the general VM FEX properties. For field  
[detail]  
descriptions, see General Properties Settings, on page  
111.  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope vmfex Enters the command mode for the specified VM FEX  
name  
interface.  
Server /chassis/adapter/vmfex # show Displays Ethernet interrupt settings. For field  
interrupt [detail]  
descriptions, see Ethernet Interrupt Settings, on page  
112.  
Step 6  
Step 7  
Step 8  
Server /chassis/adapter/vmfex # show Displays Ethernet receive queue settings. For field  
recv-queue [detail]  
descriptions, see Ethernet Receive Queue Settings, on  
page 113.  
Server /chassis/adapter/vmfex # show Displays Ethernet transmit queue settings. For field  
trans-queue [detail]  
descriptions, see Ethernet Transmit Queue Settings, on  
page 113.  
Server /chassis/adapter/vmfex # show Displays completion queue settings. For field  
comp-queue [detail]  
descriptions, see Completion Queue Settings, on page  
113.  
Step 9  
Server /chassis/adapter/vmfex # show Displays TCP offload settings. For field descriptions,  
offload [detail]  
see TCP Offload Settings, on page 114.  
Step 10  
Server /chassis/adapter/vmfex # show Displays RSS settings. For field descriptions, see  
rss [detail]  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
110  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
VM FEX Settings  
This example displays the VM FEX properties:  
Server /chassis/adapter # show vmfex detail  
Name pts0:  
MTU: 1500  
Uplink Port: 0  
MAC Address: 00:00:00:00:00:00  
CoS: N/A  
Trust Host CoS:  
PCI Order:  
VLAN: N/A  
VLAN Mode: N/A  
Rate Limiting:  
PXE Boot: disabled  
Channel Number: 0  
Port Profile:  
Uplink Failover: Enabled  
Uplink Failback Timeout: 5  
Server /chassis/adapter # scope vmfex pts0  
Server /chassis/adapter/vmfex # show interrupt  
Interrupt Count Coalescing Time (us) Coalescing Type Interrupt Mode  
--------------- -------------------- --------------- ---------------  
6
125  
MIN  
MSI  
Server /chassis/adapter/vmfex # show recv-queue  
Receive Queue Count Receive Queue Ring Size  
------------------- ------------------------------  
4
512  
Server /chassis/adapter/vmfex # show trans-queue  
Transmit Queue Count Transmit Queue Ring Size  
-------------------- -------------------------------  
1
256  
Server /chassis/adapter/vmfex # show comp-queue  
Completion Queue Count Completion Queue Ring Size  
------------------------- --------------------------  
5
1
Server /chassis/adapter/vmfex # show offload  
TCP Segment Offload TCP Rx Checksum TCP Tx Checksum Large Receive  
-------------------- ---------------- ---------------- -------------  
enabled  
enabled  
enabled  
enabled  
Server /chassis/adapter/vmfex # show rss  
TCP Rx Side Scaling  
--------------------  
enabled  
Server /chassis/adapter/vmfex #  
VM FEX Settings  
The following tables describe the VM FEX settings that you can view.  
General Properties Settings  
Name  
Description  
Name  
A user-defined name for the VM FEX.  
MTU  
The maximum transmission unit, or packet size, that this VM FEX  
accepts.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
VM FEX Settings  
Name  
Description  
Uplink Port  
The uplink port associated with this VM FEX. All traffic for this VM  
FEX goes through this uplink port.  
MAC Address  
Class of Service  
Trust Host CoS  
The MAC address associated with the VM FEX.  
The class of service to associate with traffic from this VM FEX.  
Whether the VM FEX can use the class of service provided by the host  
operating system.  
PCI Order  
The order in which this VM FEX will be used.  
The default VLAN for this VM FEX.  
Default VLAN  
VLAN Mode  
Rate Limit  
Whether VLAN trunking or access is configured.  
If rate limiting is configured, the maximum rate.  
Whether the VM FEX can be used to perform a PXE boot.  
Enable PXE Boot  
Channel Number  
If NIV mode is enabled for the adapter, the channel number assigned  
to this VM FEX.  
Port Profile  
If NIV mode is enabled for the adapter, the port profile associated with  
theVM FEX.  
Note  
This field displays the port profiles defined on the switch to  
which this server is connected.  
Enable Uplink Failover  
Failback Timeout  
If NIV mode is enabled for the adapter, whether traffic on this VM FEX  
should fail over to the secondary interface if there are communication  
problems.  
After a VM FEX has started using its secondary interface, this setting  
controls how long the primary interface must be available before the  
system resumes using the primary interface for the VM FEX.  
Ethernet Interrupt Settings  
Name  
Description  
Interrupt Count field  
The number of interrupt resources allocated to this VM FEX.  
Coalescing Time field  
The time CIMC waits between interrupts or the idle period that must  
be encountered before an interrupt is sent.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
112  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Managing Network Adapters  
VM FEX Settings  
Name  
Coalescing Type field  
Description  
This can be one of the following:  
• MIN—The system waits for the time specified in the Coalescing  
Time field before sending another interrupt event.  
• IDLE—The system does not send an interrupt until there is a  
period of no activity lasting as least as long as the time specified  
in the Coalescing Time field.  
Interrupt Mode field  
The preferred driver interrupt mode. This can be one of the following:  
• MSIx—Message Signaled Interrupts (MSI) with the optional  
extension.  
• MSI—MSI only.  
• INTx—PCI INTx interrupts.  
Ethernet Receive Queue Settings  
Name  
Description  
Receive Queue Count field  
The number of receive queue resources allocated to this VM FEX.  
Receive Queue Ring Size field  
The number of descriptors in each receive queue.  
Ethernet Transmit Queue Settings  
Name  
Description  
Transmit Queue Count field  
The number of transmit queue resources allocated to this VM FEX.  
Transmit Queue Ring Size field The number of descriptors in each transmit queue.  
Completion Queue Settings  
Name  
Description  
Completion Queue Count field The number of completion queue resources allocated to this VM FEX.  
Completion Queue Ring Size  
The number of descriptors in each completion queue.  
field  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Managing Network Adapters  
VM FEX Settings  
TCP Offload Settings  
Name  
Description  
Enable TCP Segmentation  
Offload field  
If enabled, the CPU sends large TCP packets to the hardware to be  
segmented. If disabled, the CPU segments large packets.  
Note  
This option is also known as Large Send Offload  
(LSO).  
Enable TCP Rx Offload  
Checksum Validation field  
If enabled, the CPU sends all packet checksums to the hardware for  
validation. If disabled, the CPU validates all packet checksums.  
Enable TCP Tx Offload  
Checksum Generation field  
If enabled, the CPU sends all packets to the hardware so that the  
checksum can be calculated. If disabled, the CPU calculates all packet  
checksums.  
Enable Large Receive field  
If enabled, the hardware reassembles all segmented packets before  
sending them to the CPU. If disabled, the CPU processes all large  
packets.  
Receive Side Scaling Settings  
Name  
Description  
Enable TCP Receive Side Scaling Receive Side Scaling (RSS) distributes network receive processing  
field  
across multiple CPUs in multiprocessor systems.  
If enabled, network receive processing is shared across processors  
whenever possible. If disabled, network receive processing is always  
handled by a single processor even if additional processors are available.  
Enable IPv4 RSS field  
If enabled, RSS is enabled on IPv4 networks.  
Enable TCP-IPv4 RSS field  
Enable IPv6 RSS field  
If enabled, RSS is enabled for TCP transmissions across IPv4 networks.  
If enabled, RSS is enabled on IPv6 networks.  
Enable TCP-IPv6 RSS field  
If enabled, RSS is enabled for TCP transmissions across IPv6 networks.  
Enable IPv6 Extension RSS field If enabled, RSS is enabled for IPv6 extensions.  
Enable TCP-IPv6 Extension RSS If enabled, RSS is enabled for TCP transmissions across IPv6 networks.  
field  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
114  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Managing Storage Adapters  
Managing Storage Adapters  
Create Virtual Drive from Unused Physical Drives  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope  
storageadapter slot  
Enters command mode for an installed storage card.  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # At this point, you are prompted to enter information  
create virtual-drive  
corresponding to the RAID level, the physical drives to be  
used, the size and the write policy for the new virtual drive.  
Enter the appropriate information at each prompt.  
When you have finished specifying the virtual drive  
information, you are prompted to confirm that the  
information is correct. Enter y (yes) to confirm, or n (no)  
to cancel the operation.  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # Displays the existing virtual drives.  
show virtual-drive  
This example shows how to create a new virtual drive that spans two unused physical drives.  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # create-virtual-drive  
Please enter RAID level  
(0, 1, 5, 6, 10, 50, 60) --> 1  
Please choose from the following 2 unused physical drives:  
Slot 6: size 68664 MB  
Slot 7: size 68664 MB  
Specify physical disks for span 0:  
Enter comma-separated PDs from above list--> 6,7  
Please enter Virtual Drive name (15 characters maximum)--> test_v_drive  
Please enter Virtual Drive size in MB, GB, or TB  
Example format: '400 GB' --> 1000 MB  
Optional attribute:  
Write Policy: defaults to Write Back  
OK? (y or n)--> n  
0: Write Through  
1: Write Back  
2: Write Back with Bad BBU  
3: Write Back Adaptive  
Choose number from above options--> 2  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Managing Network Adapters  
Create Virtual Drive from an Existing Drive Group  
Write Policy will be set to Write Back with Bad BBU (2 and 'write-policy\:2')  
New virtual drive will have the following characteristics:  
- Spans: '[6.7]'  
- RAID level: '1'  
- Name: 'test_v_drive'  
- Size: 1000 MB  
- Write Policy: Write Back with Bad BBU  
OK? (y or n)--> y  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show virtual-drive  
Virtual Drive Health  
Boot Drive  
Status  
Name  
Size  
RAID Level  
------------- -------------- -------------------- ---------------- ---------- ----------  
----------  
0
Good  
Good  
Good  
Good  
Good  
Optimal  
Optimal  
Optimal  
Optimal  
Optimal  
150528 MB RAID 0  
20480 MB RAID 0  
114140 MB RAID 0  
false  
1
true  
2
false  
3
false  
4
false  
test_v_drive  
new_from_test  
1000 MB  
500 MB  
RAID 1  
RAID 1  
Server /chassis/storageadapter #  
Create Virtual Drive from an Existing Drive Group  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Enters command mode for an installed storage card.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope  
storageadapter slot  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # At this point, you are prompted to enter information  
carve-virtual-drive  
corresponding to the virtual drives to be used, and the size  
and the write policy for the new virtual drive. Enter the  
appropriate information at each prompt.  
When you have finished specifying the virtual drive  
information, you are prompted to confirm that the  
information is correct. Enter y (yes) to confirm, or n (no)  
to cancel the operation.  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # Displays the existing virtual drives.  
show virtual-drive  
This example shows how to carve a new virtual drive out of unused space in an existing RAID 1 drive group:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-3  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
116  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Clearing Foreign Configuration  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # carve-virtual-drive  
< Fetching virtual drives...>  
ID Name  
RL VDSize  
MaxPossibleSize PD(s)  
----------------------------------------------------------------  
test_v_drive 1000 MB 67664 MB 6,7  
3
1
Please choose from the above list the virtual drive number  
whose space the new virtual drive will share--> 3  
New virtual drive will share space with VD 3  
Please enter Virtual Drive name (15 characters maximum)--> new_from_test  
Please enter Virtual Drive size in MB, GB, or TB (maximum: 67664 MB)  
Example format: '400 GB' --> 500 MB  
Optional attribute:  
Write Policy: defaults to Write Back  
OK? (y or n)--> y  
New virtual drive will have the following characteristics:  
- It will share space with virtual drive 3  
- Name: 'new_from_test'  
- Size: 500 MB  
OK? (y or n)--> y  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show virtual-drive  
Virtual Drive Health  
Boot Drive  
Status  
Name  
Size  
RAID Level  
------------- -------------- -------------------- ---------------- ---------- ----------  
----------  
0
Good  
Good  
Good  
Good  
Good  
Optimal  
Optimal  
Optimal  
Optimal  
Optimal  
150528 MB RAID 0  
20480 MB RAID 0  
114140 MB RAID 0  
false  
1
true  
2
false  
3
false  
4
false  
test_v_drive  
new_from_test  
1000 MB  
500 MB  
RAID 1  
RAID 1  
Server /chassis/storageadapter #  
Clearing Foreign Configuration  
Important  
This task clears all foreign configuration on the controller. Also, all configuration information from all  
physical drives hosting foreign configuration is deleted. This action cannot be reverted.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter Enters command mode for an installed storage card.  
slot  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Deleting a Virtual Drive  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter #  
You are prompted to confirm the action. Enter yes  
clear-foreign-config  
to confirm.  
Note  
If you do not enter yes, the action is  
aborted.  
This example shows how to clear all foreign configurations on the MegaRAID controller in slot 3:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # clear-foreign-config  
Are you sure you want to clear all foreign configurations on this controller?  
All data on the drive(s) will be lost.  
Enter 'yes' to confirm -> yes  
Server /chassis/storageadapter #  
Deleting a Virtual Drive  
Important  
This task deletes a virtual drive, including the drives that run the booted operating system. So back up any  
data that you want to retain before you delete a virtual drive.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot Enters command mode for an installed storage  
card.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope  
virtual-drive drive-number  
Enters command mode for the specified virtual  
drive.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive You are prompted to confirm the action. Enter  
# delete-virtual-drive yes to confirm.  
Note  
If you do not enter yes, the action is  
aborted.  
This example shows how to delete virtual drive 3.  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope virtual-drive 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive # delete-virtual-drive  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
118  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Initializing a Virtual Drive  
Are you sure you want to delete virtual drive 3?  
All data on the drive will be lost. Enter 'yes' to confirm -> yes  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive #  
Initializing a Virtual Drive  
All data on a virtual drive is lost when you initialize the drive. Before you run an initialization, back up any  
data on the virtual drive that you want to save.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot Enters command mode for an installed  
storage card.  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope  
virtual-drive drive-number  
Enters command mode for the specified  
virtual drive.  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive # Initializes the specified virtual drive.  
start-initialization  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive # (Optional) Cancels the initialization of the  
cancel-initialization  
specified virtual drive.  
Step 6  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive Displays the status of the task that is in  
# get-operation-status progress on the drive.  
This example shows how to initialize virtual drive 3 using fast initialization:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope virtual-drive 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive # start-initialization  
Are you sure you want to initialize virtual drive 3?  
All data on the drive will be lost. Enter 'yes' to confirm -> yes  
Fast (0) or full (1) initialization? -> 0  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive # get-operation-status  
progress-percent: 20%  
elapsed -seconds: 30  
operation-in-progress: initializing virtual drive  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Set as Boot Drive  
Set as Boot Drive  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot Enters command mode for an installed storage  
card.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope  
virtual-drive drive-number  
Enters command mode for the specified virtual  
drive.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter #  
set-boot-drive  
Specifies the controller to boot from this  
virtual drive.  
This example shows how to specify the controller to boot from virtual drive 3:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope virtual-drive 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive # set-boot-drive  
Are you sure you want to set virtual drive 3 as the boot drive?  
Enter 'yes' to confirm -> yes  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive #  
Modifying Attributes of a Virtual Drive  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot Enters command mode for an installed  
storage card.  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope  
virtual-drive 3  
Enters the command mode for the virtual  
drive.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
120  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Managing Network Adapters  
Making a Dedicated Hot Spare  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive # Prompts you to select a different current  
modify-attributes policy.  
This example shows how to carve a new virtual drive out of unused space in an existing RAID 1 drive group:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope virtual-drive  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive # modify-attributes  
Current write policy: Write Back  
0: Write Through  
1: Write Back  
2: Write Back even if Bad BBU  
Choose number from above options --> 0  
The following attribute will be modified:  
- Write policy: Write Through  
OK? (y or n) --> y  
operation in progress.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/virtual-drive #  
Making a Dedicated Hot Spare  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot Enters command mode for an installed storage  
card.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope  
physical-drive drive-number  
Enters command mode for the specified  
physical drive.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive You are prompted to choose a virtual drive for  
# make-dedicated-hot-spare which the dedicated hot spare is being created.  
This example shows how to make physical drive 3 a dedicated hot spare for virtual drive 6:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-3  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Making a Global Hot Spare  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope physical-drive 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive # make-dedicated-hot-spare  
5: VD_OS_1, RAID 0, 102400 MB, physical disks: 1  
6: VD_OS_2, RAID 0, 12288 MB, physical disks: 1  
7: VD_OS_3, RAID 0, 12288 MB, physical disks: 1  
8: VD_DATA_1, RAID 0, 12512 MB, physical disks: 1  
9: RAID1_2358, RAID 1, 40000 MB, physical disks: 2,3,5,8  
11: JFB_RAID1_67, RAID 1, 20000 MB, physical disks: 6,7  
12: JFB_Crv_R1_40, RAID 1, 40000 MB, physical disks: 6,7  
13: JFB_R1_10GB, RAID 1, 10000 MB, physical disks: 6,7  
Please choose from the above 8 virtual drives-->6  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive #  
Making a Global Hot Spare  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot  
Enters command mode for an installed  
storage card.  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope  
physical-drive drive-number  
Enters command mode for the specified  
physical drive.  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive #  
make-global-hot-spare  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive # Displays the status of the task that is in  
get-operation-status progress on the drive.  
This example shows how to make physical drive 3 a global hot spare:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope physical-drive 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive # make-global-hot-spare  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive #  
Preparing a Drive for Removal  
You can confirm this task only on physical drives that display the Unconfigured Good status.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
122  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Managing Network Adapters  
Removing a Drive from Hot Spare Pools  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot  
Enters command mode for an installed  
storage card.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope  
physical-drive drive-number  
Enters command mode for the specified  
physical drive.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive #  
prepare-for-removal  
This example shows how to prepare physical drive 3 for removal.  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope physical-drive 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive # prepare-for-removal  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive #  
Removing a Drive from Hot Spare Pools  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot Enters command mode for an installed  
storage card.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope  
physical-drive drive-number  
Enters command mode for the specified  
physical drive.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive Removes a drive from the host spare pool.  
# remove-hot-spare  
This example shows how to remove physical drive 3 from the hot spare pools:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope physical-drive 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive # remove-hot-spare  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Undo Preparing a Drive for Removal  
Undo Preparing a Drive for Removal  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot  
Enters command mode for an installed  
storage card.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope  
physical-drive drive-number  
Enters command mode for the specified  
physical drive.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive #  
undo-prepare-for-removal  
This example shows how to respin physical drive 3 after preparing the drive for removal.  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope physical-drive 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive # undo-prepare-for-removal  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive #  
Enabling Auto Learn Cycles for the Battery Backup Unit  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot Enters command mode for an installed storage  
card.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope bbu Enter the battery backup unit command mode.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter #  
Enables the battery auto-learn cycles  
enable-auto-learn  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
124  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Managing Network Adapters  
Disabling Auto Learn Cycles for the Battery Backup Unit  
This example shows how to enable the battery auto-learn cycles:  
Server # scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-2  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope bbu  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/bbu # enable-auto-learn  
Automatic BBU learn cycles will occur without notice if enabled.  
Are you sure? [y/n] --> y  
enable-auto-learn initiated  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/bbu #  
Disabling Auto Learn Cycles for the Battery Backup Unit  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot Enters command mode for an installed storage  
card.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope bbu Enter the battery backup unit command mode.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter #  
Disables the battery auto-learn cycles  
disable-auto-learn  
This example shows how to disables the battery auto-learn cycles:  
Server # scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-2  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope bbu  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/bbu # disable-auto-learn  
Automatic BBU learn cycles will no longer occur if disabled.  
Are you sure? [y/n] --> y  
disable-auto-learn initiated  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/bbu #  
Starting a Learn Cycle for a Battery Backup Unit  
Before You Begin  
You must be logged in as an admin to use this command.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OL-28893-01  
125  
       
Managing Network Adapters  
Toggling the Locator LED for a Physical Drive  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Server# scope chassis  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot Enters command mode for an installed storage  
card.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope bbu Enter the battery backup unit command mode.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter #  
Starts the learn cycle for the battery.  
start-learn-cycle  
This example shows how to initiate the learn cycles for a battery:  
Server # scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-2  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope bbu  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/bbu # start-learn-cycle  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/bbu #  
Toggling the Locator LED for a Physical Drive  
Before You Begin  
You must be logged in as an admin to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot Enters command mode for an installed  
storage card.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope  
physical-drive 3  
Enters the physical drive command mode.  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive Enables or disables the physical drive locator  
# locator-led {on | off} LED.  
This example shows how to enable the locator LED for physical drive 3:  
Server # scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-2  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # scope physical-drive 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive # locator-led on  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive* # commit  
Server /chassis/storageadapter/physical-drive #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
126  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Viewing Storage Controller Logs  
Viewing Storage Controller Logs  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter slot Enters command mode for an installed storage  
card.  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show log Displays the storage controller logs.  
This example shows how to display storage controller logs:  
Server # scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope storageadapter SLOT-3  
Server /chassis/storageadapter # show log  
Time  
Severity  
--------  
Warning  
Info  
Description  
----  
-------------  
Fri March 1 09:52:19 2013  
Fri March 1 07:50:19 2013  
Fri March 1 07:50:19 2013  
Fri March 1 07:48:19 2013  
Fri March 1 07:47:19 2013  
Fri March 1 07:45:19 2013  
Predictive Failure  
Battery charge complete  
Battery charge started  
Battery relearn complete  
Battery is discharging  
Battery relearn started  
Info  
Info  
Info  
Info  
Server /chassis/storageadapter #  
Backing Up and Restoring the Adapter Configuration  
Exporting the Adapter Configuration  
The adapter configuration can be exported as an XML file to a TFTP server.  
Important  
If any firmware or BIOS updates are in progress, do not export the adapter configuration until those tasks  
are complete.  
Before You Begin  
A supported Virtual Interface Card (VIC) must be installed in the chassis and the server must be powered on.  
Obtain the TFTP server IP address.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Managing Network Adapters  
Importing the Adapter Configuration  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the PCI  
index  
slot number specified by index.  
The server must be powered on before you can view  
or change adapter settings.  
Note  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/adapter #  
export-vnic protocol remote  
server IP address  
Starts the export operation. The adapter configuration file  
will be stored at the specified path and filename on the remote  
server at the specified IP address. The protocol can be one  
of the following:  
TFTP  
FTP  
•
•
•
•
•
SFTP  
SCP  
HTTP  
This example exports the configuration of adapter 1:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # export-vnic ftp 192.0.20.34 //test/dnld-ucs-k9-bundle.1.0.2h.bin  
Server /chassis/adapter #  
Importing the Adapter Configuration  
Important  
If any firmware or BIOS updates are in progress, do not import the adapter configuration until those tasks  
are complete.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # scope adapter Enters the command mode for the adapter card at the PCI  
index  
slot number specified by index.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
128  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Restoring Adapter Defaults  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Note  
The server must be powered on before you can  
view or change adapter settings.  
Step 3  
Server /chassis/adapter #  
import-vnic tftp-ip-address  
path-and-filename  
Starts the import operation. The adapter downloads the  
configuration file from the specified path on the TFTP server  
at the specified IP address. The configuration will be  
installed during the next server reboot.  
This example imports a configuration for the adapter in PCI slot 1:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # scope adapter 1  
Server /chassis/adapter # import-vnic 192.0.2.34 /ucs/backups/adapter4.xml  
Import succeeded.  
New VNIC adapter settings will take effect upon the next server reset.  
Server /chassis/adapter #  
What to Do Next  
Reboot the server to apply the imported configuration.  
Restoring Adapter Defaults  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis #  
adapter-reset-defaults index  
Restores factory default settings for the adapter at  
the PCI slot number specified by the index  
argument.  
This example restores the default configuration of the adapter in PCI slot 1:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # adapter-reset-defaults 1  
This operation will reset the adapter to factory default.  
All your configuration will be lost.  
Continue?[y|N] y  
Server /chassis #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Network Adapters  
Managing Adapter Firmware  
Managing Adapter Firmware  
Adapter Firmware  
A Cisco UCS C-Series network adapter contains the following firmware components:  
• Adapter firmware—The main operating firmware, consisting of an active and a backup image, can be  
installed from the CIMC GUI or CLI interface or from the Host Upgrade Utility (HUU). You can upload  
a firmware image from either a local file system or a TFTP server.  
• Bootloader firmware—The bootloader firmware cannot be installed from the CIMC GUI or CLI. You  
can install this firmware using the Host Upgrade Utility.  
Installing Adapter Firmware  
Important  
If any firmware or BIOS updates are in progress, do not install the adapter firmware until those tasks are  
complete.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # update-adapter-fw Downloads the specified adapter firmware file from the  
tftp-ip-address path-and-filename  
{activate | no-activate} [ pci-slot ]  
[ pci-slot ]  
TFTP server, then installs the firmware as the backup  
image on one or two specified adapters or, if no adapter  
is specified, on all adapters. If the activate keyword is  
specified, the new firmware is activated after installation.  
Step 3  
Server /chassis #  
(Optional)  
recover-adapter-update [ pci-slot ] Clears an incomplete firmware update condition on one  
[ pci-slot ]  
or two specified adapters or, if no adapter is specified,  
on all adapters.  
This example begins an adapter firmware upgrade on the adapter in PCI slot 1:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # update-adapter-fw 192.0.2.34 /ucs/adapters/adapter4.bin activate 1  
Server /chassis #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
130  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Managing Network Adapters  
Activating Adapter Firmware  
What to Do Next  
To activate the new firmware, see Activating Adapter Firmware, on page 131.  
Activating Adapter Firmware  
Important  
While the activation is in progress, do not:  
Reset, power off, or shut down the server.  
Reboot or reset CIMC.  
•
•
•
•
Activate any other firmware.  
Export technical support or configuration data.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # activate-adapter-fw Activates adapter firmware image 1 or 2 on the adapter  
pci-slot {1 | 2}  
in the specified PCI slot.  
Note  
The changes will take effect upon the next  
server reboot.  
This example activates adapter firmware image 2 on the adapter in PCI slot 1:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # activate-adapter-fw 1 2  
Firmware image activation suceeded  
Please reset the server to run the activated image  
Server /chassis #  
What to Do Next  
Reboot the server to apply the changes.  
Resetting the Adapter  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Managing Network Adapters  
Resetting the Adapter  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the chassis command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope chassis  
Server/chassis # adapter-reset index Resets the adapter at the PCI slot number specified by  
the index argument.  
Note  
Resetting the adapter also resets the  
host.  
This example resets the adapter in PCI slot 1:  
Server# scope chassis  
Server /chassis # adapter-reset 1  
This operation will reset the adapter and the host if it is on.  
You may lose connectivity to the CIMC and may have to log in again.  
Continue?[y|N] y  
Server /chassis #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
132  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
C H A P T E R  
10  
Configuring Communication Services  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
•
•
Configuring HTTP  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to configure HTTP.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope http  
Enters the HTTP command mode.  
Server /http # set enabled {yes | no} Enables or disables HTTP and HTTPS service on the  
CIMC.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /http # set http-port number Sets the port to use for HTTP communication. The  
default is 80.  
Server /http # set https-port number Sets the port to use for HTTPS communication. The  
default is 443.  
Server /http # set http-redirect {yes Enables or disables the redirection of an HTTP request  
| no}  
to HTTPS.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OL-28893-01  
133  
       
Configuring Communication Services  
Configuring SSH  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 6  
Step 7  
Server /http # set timeout seconds Sets the number of seconds to wait between HTTP  
requests before the CIMC times out and terminates the  
session.  
Enter an integer between 60 and 10,800. The default is  
1,800 seconds.  
Server /http # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
This example configures HTTP for the CIMC:  
Server# scope http  
Server /http # set enabled yes  
Server /http *# set http-port 80  
Server /http *# set https-port 443  
Server /http *# set http-redirect yes  
Server /http *# set timeout 1800  
Server /http *# commit  
Server /http # show  
HTTP Port HTTPS Port Timeout Active Sessions Enabled HTTP Redirected  
---------- ---------- -------- --------------- ------- ----------------  
80  
443  
1800  
0
yes  
yes  
Server /http #  
Configuring SSH  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to configure SSH.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the SSH command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope ssh  
Server /ssh # set enabled {yes | no} Enables or disables SSH on the CIMC.  
Server /ssh # set ssh-port number Sets the port to use for secure shell access. The default  
is 22.  
Step 4  
Server /ssh # set timeout seconds Sets the number of seconds to wait before the system  
considers an SSH request to have timed out.  
Enter an integer between 60 and 10,800. The default  
is 300 seconds.  
Step 5  
Step 6  
Server /ssh # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
(Optional) Displays the SSH configuration.  
Server /ssh # show [detail]  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
134  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Configuring Communication Services  
Configuring XML API  
This example configures SSH for the CIMC:  
Server# scope ssh  
Server /ssh # set enabled yes  
Server /ssh *# set ssh-port 22  
Server /ssh *# set timeout 600  
Server /ssh *# commit  
Server /ssh # show  
SSH Port  
Timeout Active Sessions Enabled  
---------- -------- --------------- -------  
22  
600  
1
yes  
Server /ssh #  
Configuring XML API  
XML API for CIMC  
The Cisco CIMC XML application programming interface (API) is a programmatic interface to CIMC for a  
C-Series Rack-Mount Server. The API accepts XML documents through HTTP or HTTPS.  
For detailed information about the XML API, see Cisco UCS Rack-Mount Servers CIMC XML API  
Programmer’s Guide.  
Enabling XML API  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope xmlapi  
Enters XML API command mode.  
Server /xmlapi # set enabled {yes | no} Enables or disables XML API control of CIMC.  
Server /xmlapi # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system  
configuration.  
This example enables XML API control of CIMC and commits the transaction:  
Server# scope xmlapi  
Server /xmlapi # set enabled yes  
Server /xmlapi *# commit  
Server /xmlapi # show detail  
XMLAPI Settings:  
Enabled: yes  
Active Sessions: 0  
Max Sessions: 4  
Server /xmlapi #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Configuring Communication Services  
Configuring IPMI  
Configuring IPMI  
IPMI Over LAN  
Intelligent Platform Management Interface (IPMI) defines the protocols for interfacing with a service processor  
embedded in a server platform. This service processor is called a Baseboard Management Controller (BMC)  
and resides on the server motherboard. The BMC links to a main processor and other on-board elements using  
a simple serial bus.  
During normal operations, IPMI lets a server operating system obtain information about system health and  
control system hardware. For example, IPMI enables the monitoring of sensors, such as temperature, fan  
speeds and voltages, for proactive problem detection. If server temperature rises above specified levels, the  
server operating system can direct the BMC to increase fan speed or reduce processor speed to address the  
problem.  
Configuring IPMI over LAN  
Configure IPMI over LAN when you want to manage the CIMC with IPMI messages.  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope ipmi  
Enters the IPMI command mode.  
Server /ipmi # set enabled Enables or disables IPMI access on this server.  
{yes | no}  
Step 3  
Server /ipmi # set  
Specifies the highest privilege level that can be assigned to an IPMI  
privilege-level {readonly | session on this server. This can be:  
user | admin}  
• readonly — IPMI users can view information but cannot  
make any changes. If you select this option, IPMI users with  
the "Administrator", "Operator", or "User" user roles can only  
create read-only IPMI sessions, regardless of their other IPMI  
privileges.  
• user — IPMI users can perform some functions but cannot  
perform administrative tasks. If you select this option, IPMI  
users with the "Administrator" or "Operator" user role can  
create user and read-only sessions on this server.  
• admin — IPMI users can perform all available actions. If you  
select this option, IPMI users with the "Administrator" user  
role can create admin, user, and read-only sessions on this  
server.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
136  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Configuring Communication Services  
Configuring SNMP  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /ipmi # set  
encryption-key key  
Sets the IPMI encryption key to use for IPMI communications. The  
key value must be 40 hexadecimal numbers.  
Server /ipmi # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
This example configures IPMI over LAN for the CIMC:  
Server# scope ipmi  
Server /ipmi # set enabled yes  
Server /ipmi *# set privilege-level admin  
Server /ipmi *# set encryption-key abcdef01234567890abcdef01234567890abcdef  
Server /ipmi *# commit  
Server /ipmi # show  
Enabled Encryption Key  
------- ---------------------------------------- ---------------------  
yes abcdef01234567890abcdef01234567890abcdef admin  
Privilege Level Limit  
Server /ipmi #  
Configuring SNMP  
SNMP  
The Cisco UCS C-Series Rack-Mount Servers support the Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP)  
for viewing server configuration and status and for sending fault and alert information by SNMP traps. For  
information on Management Information Base (MIB) files supported by CIMC, see the MIB Quick Reference  
Configuring SNMP Properties  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope snmp  
Enters SNMP command mode.  
Server /snmp # set enabled {yes Enables or disables SNMP.  
| no}  
Note  
SNMP must be enabled and saved before additional  
SNMP configuration commands are accepted.  
Step 3  
Server /snmp # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Configuring Communication Services  
Configuring SNMP Properties  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 4  
Server /snmp # set  
community-str community  
Specifies the default SNMP v1 or v2c community name that  
CIMC includes on any trap messages it sends to the SNMP  
host. The name can be up to 18 characters.  
Step 5  
Step 6  
Server /snmp #  
setcommunity-access  
This can be one of the following : Disabled, Limited, or Full.  
Server /snmp #  
settrap-community-str  
Specifies the SNMP community group to which trap  
information should be sent. The name can be up to 18  
characters  
Step 7  
Server /snmp # set sys-contact Specifies the system contact person responsible for the SNMP  
contact  
implementation. The contact information can be up to 254  
characters, such as an email address or a name and telephone  
number. To enter a value that contains spaces, you must  
enclose the entry with quotation marks.  
Step 8  
Step 9  
Server /snmp # set sys-location Specifies the location of the host on which the SNMP agent  
location  
(server) runs. The location information can be up to 254  
characters. To enter a value that contains spaces, you must  
enclose the entry with quotation marks.  
Server /snmp # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
This example configures the SNMP properties and commits the transaction:  
Server# scope snmp  
Server /snmp # set enabled yes  
Server /snmp *# commit  
Server /snmp # set community-str cimcpublic  
Server /snmp # set community-access Full  
Server /snmp # set trap-community-str public  
Server /snmp *# set sys-contact "User Name <username@example.com> +1-408-555-1212"  
Server /snmp *# set sys-location "San Jose, California"  
Server /snmp *# commit  
Server /snmp # show detail  
SNMP Settings:  
SNMP Port: 161  
System Contact: User Name <username@example.com> +1-408-555-1212  
System Location: San Jose, California  
SNMP Community: cimcpublic  
SNMP Trap community: public  
SNMP Community access: Full  
Enabled: yes  
Server /snmp #  
What to Do Next  
Configure SNMP trap settings as described in Configuring SNMP Trap Settings, on page 139.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
138  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Communication Services  
Configuring SNMP Trap Settings  
Configuring SNMP Trap Settings  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
•
•
SNMP must be enabled and saved before trap settings can be configured.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope snmp  
Enters the SNMP command mode.  
Server /snmp # scope  
trap-destinations number  
Enters the SNMP trap destination command mode for  
the specified destination. Four SNMP trap destinations  
are available. The destination number is an integer  
between 1 and 15.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /snmp/trap-destinations # set Enables or disables the SNMP trap destination.  
enabled {yes | no}  
Server /snmp/trap-destinations # set Specify the desired SNMP version of the trap message.  
version {1 | 2 | 3}  
Note  
SNMPv3 traps will be delivered only to  
locations where the SNMPv3 user and key  
values are configured correctly.  
Step 5  
Server /snmp/trap-destinations # set Specifies whether SNMP notification messages are  
type {trap | inform}  
sent as simple traps or as inform requests requiring  
acknowledgment by the receiver.  
Note  
The inform option can be chosen only for V2  
users.  
Step 6  
Step 7  
Server /snmp/trap-destinations # set  
user user  
Server /snmp/trap-destination # set  
v4-addr ip-address  
Specifies the destination IP address to which SNMP  
trap information is sent.  
Step 8  
Server /snmp/trap-destination #  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
commit  
This example configures general SNMP trap settings and trap destination number 1 and commits the transaction:  
Server# scope snmp  
Server /snmp # Scope trap-destinations 1  
Server /snmp/trap-destination *# set enabled yes  
Server /snmp/trap-destination *# set version 2  
Server /snmp/trap-destination *# set type inform  
Server /snmp/trap-destination *# set user user1  
Server /snmp/trap-destination *# set v4-addr 192.2.3.4  
Server /snmp/trap-destination *# commit  
Server /snmp/trap-destination # show detail  
Trap Destination 1:  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Configuring Communication Services  
Sending a Test SNMP Trap Message  
Enabled: yes  
SNMP version: 2  
Trap type: inform  
SNMP user: user1  
IPv4 Address: 192.2.3.4  
Delete Trap: no  
Server /snmp/trap-destination #  
Sending a Test SNMP Trap Message  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Enters the SNMP command mode.  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope snmp  
Server /snmp # sendSNMPtrap Sends an SNMP test trap to the configured SNMP trap  
destination that are enabled.  
Note  
The trap must be configured and enabled in order  
to send a test message.  
This example sends a test message to all the enabled SNMP trap destinations:  
Server# scope snmp  
Server /snmp # sendSNMPtrap  
SNMP Test Trap sent to the destination.  
Server /snmp #  
Configuring SNMPv3 Users  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to perform this task.  
•
•
SNMP must be enabled and saved before these configuration commands are accepted.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope snmp  
Enters the SNMP command mode.  
Server /snmp # scope v3users  
number  
Enters the SNMPv3 users command mode for the  
specified user number.  
Step 3  
Server /snmp/v3users # set v3add Adds or deletes an SNMPv3 user. This can be one of the  
{yes | no}  
following:  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
140  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Configuring Communication Services  
Configuring SNMPv3 Users  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
• yes—This user is enabled as an SNMPv3 user and  
is allowed to access the SNMP OID tree.  
Note  
The security name and security level must  
also be configured at this time or the user  
addition will fail.  
• no—This user configuration is deleted.  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /snmp/v3users # set  
v3security-name security-name  
Enter an SNMP username for this user.  
Server /snmp/v3users # set  
Select a security level for this user. This can be one of the  
v3security-level {noauthnopriv | following:  
authnopriv | authpriv}  
• noauthnopriv—The user does not require an  
authorization or privacy password.  
• authnopriv—The user requires an authorization  
password but not a privacy password. If you select  
this option, you must configure an authentication  
key.  
• authpriv—The user requires both an authorization  
password and a privacy password. If you select this  
option, you must configure an authentication key  
and a private encryption key.  
Step 6  
Step 7  
Step 8  
Step 9  
Server /snmp/v3users # set v3proto Select an authentication protocol for this user.  
{MD5 | SHA}  
Server /snmp/v3users # set  
v3auth-key auth-key  
Enter an authorization password for this user.  
Server /snmp/v3users # set  
v3priv-proto {DES | AES}  
Select an encryption protocol for this user.  
Server /snmp/v3users # set  
v3priv-auth-key priv-auth-key  
Enter a private encryption key (privacy password) for this  
user.  
Step 10  
Server /snmp/v3users # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
This example configures SNMPv3 user number 2 and commits the transaction:  
Server# scope snmp  
Server /snmp # scope v3users 2  
Server /snmp/v3users # set v3add yes  
Server /snmp/v3users *# set v3security-name ucsSNMPV3user  
Server /snmp/v3users *# set v3security-level authpriv  
Server /snmp/v3users *# set v3proto SHA  
Server /snmp/v3users *# set v3auth-key  
Please enter v3auth-key:ex4mp1ek3y  
Please confirm v3auth-key:ex4mp1ek3y  
Server /snmp/v3users *# set v3priv-proto AES  
Server /snmp/v3users *# set v3priv-auth-key  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Communication Services  
Configuring SNMPv3 Users  
Please enter v3priv-auth-key:!1@2#3$4%5^6&7*8  
Please confirm v3priv-auth-key:!1@2#3$4%5^6&7*8  
Server /snmp/v3users *# commit  
Settings are being applied ... allow a few minutes for the process to complete  
Server /snmp/v3users # show detail  
User 2:  
Add User: yes  
Security Name: ucsSNMPV3user  
Security Level: authpriv  
Auth Type: SHA  
Auth Key: ******  
Encryption: AES  
Private Key: ******  
Server /snmp/v3users #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
142  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
C H A P T E R  
11  
Managing Certificates  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
•
Managing the Server Certificate  
You can generate a certificate signing request (CSR) to obtain a new certificate, and you can upload the new  
certificate to the CIMC to replace the current server certificate. The server certificate may be signed either  
by a public Certificate Authority (CA), such as Verisign, or by your own certificate authority.  
Procedure  
Step 1 Generate the CSR from the CIMC.  
Step 2 Submit the CSR file to a certificate authority that will issue and sign your certificate. If your organization  
generates its own self-signed certificates, you can use the CSR file to generate a self-signed certificate.  
Step 3 Upload the new certificate to the CIMC.  
Note  
The uploaded certificate must be created from a CSR generated by the CIMC. Do not upload a  
certificate that was not created by this method.  
Generating a Certificate Signing Request  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to configure certificates.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OL-28893-01  
143  
     
Managing Certificates  
Generating a Certificate Signing Request  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope certificate  
Enters the certificate command mode.  
Server /certificate # generate-csr  
Launches a dialog for the generation of a certificate  
signing request (CSR).  
You will be prompted to enter the following information for the certificate signing request:  
Common Name (CN)  
Organization Name (O)  
Organization Unit (OU)  
Locality (L)  
The fully qualified hostname of the CIMC.  
The organization requesting the certificate.  
The organizational unit.  
The city or town in which the company requesting  
the certificate is headquartered.  
StateName (S)  
Country Code (CC)  
Email  
The state or province in which the company  
requesting the certificate is headquartered.  
The two-letter ISO country code for the country in  
which the company is headquartered.  
The administrative email contact at the company.  
After you have entered the requested information, the system will generate and display a certificate signing  
request in the console output. A CSR file will not be created, but you can copy the CSR information from the  
console output and paste the information into a text file.  
This example generates a certificate signing request:  
Server# scope certificate  
Server /certificate # generate-csr  
Common Name (CN): test.example.com  
Organization Name (O): Example, Inc.  
Organization Unit (OU): Test Department  
Locality (L): San Jose  
StateName (S): CA  
Country Code (CC): US  
Email: user@example.com  
Continue to generate CSR?[y|N]y  
-----BEGIN CERTIFICATE REQUEST-----  
MIIB/zCCAWgCAQAwgZkxCzAJBgNVBAYTAlVTMQswCQYDVQQIEwJDQTEVMBMGA1UE  
BxMMU2FuIEpvc2UsIENBMRUwEwYDVQQKEwxFeGFtcGxlIEluYy4xEzARBgNVBAsT  
ClRlc3QgR3JvdXAxGTAXBgNVBAMTEHRlc3QuZXhhbXBsZS5jb20xHzAdBgkqhkiG  
9w0BCQEWEHVzZXJAZXhhbXBsZS5jb20wgZ8wDQYJKoZIhvcNAQEBBQADgY0AMIGJ  
AoGBAMZw4nTepNIDhVzb0j7Z2Je4xAG56zmSHRMQeOGHemdh66u2/XAoLx7YCcYU  
ZgAMivyCsKgb/6CjQtsofvzxmC/eAehuK3/SINv7wd6Vv2pBt6ZpXgD4VBNKONDl  
GMbkPayVlQjbG4MD2dx2+H8EH3LMtdZrgKvPxPTE+bF5wZVNAgMBAAGgJTAjBgkq  
hkiG9w0BCQcxFhMUQSBjaGFsbGVuZ2UgcGFzc3dvcmQwDQYJKoZIhvcNAQEFBQAD  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
144  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing Certificates  
Creating a Self-Signed Certificate  
gYEAG61CaJoJaVMhzCl903O6Mg51zq1zXcz75+VFj2I6rH9asckCld3mkOVx5gJU  
Ptt5CVQpNgNLdvbDPSsXretysOhqHmp9+CLv8FDuy1CDYfuaLtvlWvfhevskV0j6  
mK3Ku+YiORnv6DhxrOoqau8r/hyI/L43l7IPN1HhOi3oha4=  
-----END CERTIFICATE REQUEST-----  
Copy everything from "-----BEGIN ..." to "END CERTIFICATE REQUEST-----",  
paste to a file, send to your chosen CA for signing,  
and finally upload the signed certificate via upload command.  
---OR---  
Continue to self sign CSR and overwrite the current certificate?  
All HTTPS and SSH sessions will be disconnected. [y|N]N  
What to Do Next  
Perform one of the following tasks:  
If you do not want to obtain a certificate from a public certificate authority, and if your organization  
does not operate its own certificate authority, you can allow CIMC to internally generate a self-signed  
certificate from the CSR and upload it immediately to the server. Type y after the final prompt in the  
example to perform this action.  
•
If your organization operates its own certificate server for generating self-signed certificates, copy the  
command output from "-----BEGIN ..." to "END CERTIFICATE REQUEST-----" and paste to a file  
named csr.txt. Input the CSR file to your certificate server to generate a self-signed certificate.  
•
•
If you will obtain a certificate from a public certificate authority, copy the command output from  
"-----BEGIN ..." to "END CERTIFICATE REQUEST-----" and paste to a file named csr.txt. Submit the  
CSR file to the certificate authority to obtain a signed certificate.  
If you did not use the first option, in which CIMC internally generates and uploads a self-signed certificate,  
you must upload the new certificate using the upload command in certificate command mode.  
Creating a Self-Signed Certificate  
As an alternative to using a public Certificate Authority (CA) to generate and sign a server certificate, you  
can operate your own CA and sign your own certificates. This section shows commands for creating a CA  
and generating a server certificate using the OpenSSL certificate server running on Linux. For detailed  
information about OpenSSL, see http://www.openssl.org.  
Note  
These commands are to be entered on a Linux server with the OpenSSL package, not in the CIMC CLI.  
Before You Begin  
Obtain and install a certificate server software package on a server within your organization.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Certificates  
Creating a Self-Signed Certificate  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1 openssl genrsa -out CA_keyfilename  
This command generates an RSA private key that will  
be used by the CA.  
keysize  
Note  
To allow the CA to access the key without user  
input, do not use the -des3 option for this  
command.  
Example:  
# openssl genrsa -out ca.key 1024  
The specified file name contains an RSA key of the  
specified key size.  
Step 2 openssl req -new -x509 -days numdays  
This command generates a new self-signed certificate  
-key CA_keyfilename -out CA_certfilename for the CA using the specified key. The certificate is  
valid for the specified period. The command prompts  
the user for additional certificate information.  
# openssl req -new -x509 -days 365  
The certificate server is an active CA.  
-key ca.key -out ca.crt  
Example:  
Step 3 echo "nsCertType = server" >  
This command adds a line to the OpenSSL configuration  
file to designate the certificate as a server-only  
certificate. This designation is a defense against a  
man-in-the-middle attack, in which an authorized client  
attempts to impersonate the server.  
openssl.conf  
Example:  
# echo "nsCertType = server" >  
openssl.conf  
The OpenSSL configuration file openssl.conf contains  
the statement "nsCertType = server".  
Step 4 openssl x509 -req -days numdays -in  
CSR_filename -CA CA_certfilename  
This command directs the CA to use your CSR file to  
generate a server certificate.  
-set_serial 04 -CAkey CA_keyfilename -out  
server_certfilename -extfile openssl.conf  
Your server certificate is contained in the output file.  
Example:  
# openssl x509 -req -days 365 -in  
csr.txt -CA ca.crt -set_serial 04  
-CAkey ca.key -out myserver05.crt  
-extfile openssl.conf  
This example shows how to create a CA and to generate a server certificate signed by the new CA. These  
commands are entered on a Linux server running OpenSSL.  
# /usr/bin/openssl genrsa -out ca.key 1024  
Generating RSA private key, 1024 bit long modulus  
.............++++++  
.....++++++  
e is 65537 (0x10001)  
# /usr/bin/openssl req -new -x509 -days 365 -key ca.key -out ca.crt  
You are about to be asked to enter information that will be incorporated  
into your certificate request.  
What you are about to enter is what is called a Distinguished Name or a  
DN.  
There are quite a few fields but you can leave some blank  
For some fields there will be a default value,  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
146  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing Certificates  
Uploading a Server Certificate  
If you enter '.', the field will be left blank.  
-----  
Country Name (2 letter code) [GB]:US  
State or Province Name (full name) [Berkshire]:California  
Locality Name (eg, city) [Newbury]:San Jose  
Organization Name (eg, company) [My Company Ltd]:Example Incorporated  
Organizational Unit Name (eg, section) []:Unit A  
Common Name (eg, your name or your server's hostname) []:example.com  
Email Address []:admin@example.com  
# echo "nsCertType = server" > openssl.conf  
# /usr/bin/openssl x509 -req -days 365 -in csr.txt -CA ca.crt -set_serial 01 -CAkey ca.key -out server.crt  
-extfile openssl.conf  
Signature ok  
subject=/C=US/ST=California/L=San Jose/O=Example Inc./OU=Unit  
A/CN=example.com/emailAddress=john@example.com  
Getting CA Private Key  
#
What to Do Next  
Upload the new certificate to the CIMC.  
Uploading a Server Certificate  
Before You Begin  
You must log in as a user with admin privileges to upload a certificate.  
The certificate to be uploaded must be available as readable text. During the upload procedure, you will copy  
the certificate text and paste it into the CLI.  
Note  
Note  
You must first generate a CSR using the CIMC certificate management CSR generation procedure, and  
you must use that CSR to obtain the certificate for uploading. Do not upload a certificate that was not  
obtained by this method.  
All current HTTPS and SSH sessions are disconnected when the new server certificate is uploaded.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope certificate  
Enters the certificate command mode.  
Server /certificate # upload  
Launches a dialog for entering and uploading the  
new server certificate.  
Copy the certificate text, paste it into the console when prompted, and type CTRL+D to upload the certificate.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing Certificates  
Uploading a Server Certificate  
This example uploads a new certificate to the server:  
Server# scope certificate  
Server /certificate # upload  
Please paste your certificate here, when finished, press CTRL+D.  
-----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----  
MIIB/zCCAWgCAQAwgZkxCzAJBgNVBAYTAlVTMQswCQYDVQQIEwJDQTEVMBMGA1UE  
BxMMU2FuIEpvc2UsIENBMRUwEwYDVQQKEwxFeGFtcGxlIEluYy4xEzARBgNVBAsT  
ClRlc3QgR3JvdXAxGTAXBgNVBAMTEHRlc3QuZXhhbXBsZS5jb20xHzAdBgkqhkiG  
9w0BCQEWEHVzZXJAZXhhbXBsZS5jb20wgZ8wDQYJKoZIhvcNAQEBBQADgY0AMIGJ  
AoGBAMZw4nTepNIDhVzb0j7Z2Je4xAG56zmSHRMQeOGHemdh66u2/XAoLx7YCcYU  
ZgAMivyCsKgb/6CjQtsofvzxmC/eAehuK3/SINv7wd6Vv2pBt6ZpXgD4VBNKONDl  
GMbkPayVlQjbG4MD2dx2+H8EH3LMtdZrgKvPxPTE+bF5wZVNAgMBAAGgJTAjBgkq  
hkiG9w0BCQcxFhMUQSBjaGFsbGVuZ2UgcGFzc3dvcmQwDQYJKoZIhvcNAQEFBQAD  
gYEAG61CaJoJaVMhzCl903O6Mg51zq1zXcz75+VFj2I6rH9asckCld3mkOVx5gJU  
Ptt5CVQpNgNLdvbDPSsXretysOhqHmp9+CLv8FDuy1CDYfuaLtvlWvfhevskV0j6  
mK3Ku+YiORnv6DhxrOoqau8r/hyI/L43l7IPN1HhOi3oha4=  
-----END CERTIFICATE-----  
<CTRL+D>  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
148  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
C H A P T E R  
12  
Configuring Platform Event Filters  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
•
•
•
Platform Event Filters  
A platform event filter (PEF) can trigger an action and generate an alert when a critical hardware-related event  
occurs. For each PEF, you can choose the action to be taken (or take no action) when a platform event occurs.  
You can also choose to generate and send an alert when a platform event occurs. Alerts are sent as an SNMP  
trap, so you must configure an SNMP trap destination before the alerts can be sent.  
You can globally enable or disable the generation of platform event alerts. When disabled, alerts are not sent  
even if PEFs are configured to send them.  
Enabling Platform Event Alerts  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope fault  
Enters the fault command mode.  
Server /fault # set  
Enables platform event alerts.  
platform-event-enabled yes  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OL-28893-01  
149  
         
Configuring Platform Event Filters  
Disabling Platform Event Alerts  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /fault # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system  
configuration.  
Server /fault # show [detail]  
(Optional) Displays the platform event alert  
configuration.  
The following example enables platform event alerts:  
Server# scope fault  
Server /fault # set platform-event-enabled yes  
Server /fault *# commit  
Server /fault # show  
SNMP Community String Platform Event Enabled  
--------------------- -----------------------  
public  
yes  
Server /fault #  
Disabling Platform Event Alerts  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope fault  
Enters the fault command mode.  
Server /fault # set  
Disables platform event alerts.  
platform-event-enabled no  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /fault # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system  
configuration.  
Server /fault # show [detail]  
(Optional) Displays the platform event alert  
configuration.  
The following example disables platform event alerts:  
Server# scope fault  
Server /fault # set platform-event-enabled no  
Server /fault *# commit  
Server /fault # show  
SNMP Community String Platform Event Enabled  
--------------------- -----------------------  
public  
no  
Server /fault #  
Configuring Platform Event Filters  
You can configure actions and alerts for the following platform event filters:  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
150  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Configuring Platform Event Filters  
Configuring Platform Event Filters  
ID  
Platform Event Filter  
1
Temperature Critical Assert Filter  
2
Temperature Warning Assert Filter  
Voltage Critical Assert Filter  
Current Assert Filter  
3
4
5
Fan Critical Assert Filter  
6
Processor Assert Filter  
7
Power Supply Critical Assert Filter  
Power Supply Warning Assert Filter  
Power Supply Redundancy Lost Filter  
Discrete Power Supply Assert Filter  
Memory Assert Filter  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
Drive Slot Assert Filter  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope fault  
Enters the fault command mode.  
Server /fault # scope pef id  
Enters the platform event filter command mode for the  
specified event.  
See the Platform Event Filter table for event ID numbers.  
Step 3  
Server /fault/pef # set action  
Selects the desired system action when this event occurs. The  
{none | reboot | power-cycle | action can be one of the following:  
power-off}  
• none —No system action is taken.  
• reboot —The server is rebooted.  
• power-cycle —The server is power cycled.  
• power-off —The server is powered off.  
Step 4  
Server /fault/pef # set send-alert Enables or disables the sending of a platform event alert for  
{yes | no}  
this event.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Platform Event Filters  
Configuring Platform Event Trap Settings  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Note  
For an alert to be sent, the filter trap settings must  
be configured properly and platform event alerts  
must be enabled.  
Step 5  
Server /fault/pef # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
This example configures the platform event alert for an event:  
Server# scope fault  
Server /fault # scope pef 11  
Server /fault/pef # set action reboot  
Server /fault/pef *# set send-alert yes  
Server /fault/pef *# commit  
Server /fault/pef # show  
Platform Event Filter Event  
Action  
Send Alert  
--------------------- --------------------------- ----------- ------------------  
11  
Memory Assert Filter  
reboot  
yes  
Server /fault/pef #  
What to Do Next  
If you configure any PEFs to send an alert, enable platform event alerts.  
Configuring Platform Event Trap Settings  
Before You Begin  
You must log in with admin privileges to perform this task.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope fault  
Enters the fault command mode.  
Server /fault # scope pef-destinations  
Enters the platform event filter destinations  
command mode.  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server /fault /pef-destinations # set  
enabled yes  
Enables the platform event trap destination.  
Server /fault /pef-destinations # set addr Specifies the destination IP address to which  
IP Address  
platform event trap information is sent.  
Step 5  
Server /fault /pef-destinations # commit Commits the transaction to the system  
configuration.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
152  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Configuring Platform Event Filters  
Interpreting Platform Event Traps  
This example configures general platform event trap settings and trap destination number 1 and commits the  
transaction:  
Server# scope fault  
Server /fault # scope pef-destination 1  
Server /fault /pef-destinations *# set enabled yes  
Server /fault /pef-destinations *# set addr 1.2.3.4  
Server /fault /pef-destinations *# commit  
Server /fault /pef-destinations # show  
Trap Destination 1:  
IP Address: 1.2.3.4  
Enabled: yes  
Server /fault /pef-destinations #  
Interpreting Platform Event Traps  
A CIMC platform event alert contains an enterprise object identifier (OID) in the form  
1.3.6.1.4.1.3183.1.1.0.event. The first ten fields of the OID represent the following information:  
iso(1).org(3).dod(6).internet(1).private(4).enterprises(1).wired_for_management(3183).PET(1).version(1).version(0),  
indicating an IPMI platform event trap (PET) version 1.0 message. The last field is an event number, indicating  
the specific condition or alert being notified.  
Platform Event Trap Descriptions  
The following table provides a description of the event being notified in a platform event trap message, based  
on the event number in the trap OID.  
Event Number [Note 1]  
Platform Event Description  
Test Trap  
0
0h  
65799  
65801  
131330  
131337  
196871  
262402  
459776  
010107h  
010109h  
020102h  
020109h  
030107h  
040102h  
070400h  
Temperature Warning  
Temperature Critical  
Under Voltage, Critical  
Voltage Critical  
Current Warning  
Fan Critical  
Processor related (IOH-Thermalert/Caterr sensor) – predictive failure  
deasserted  
459777  
070401h  
Processor related (IOH-Thermalert/Caterr sensor) – predictive failure  
asserted  
460032  
460033  
524533  
524551  
070500h  
070501h  
0800F5h  
080107h  
Processor Power Warning – limit not exceeded  
Processor Power Warning – limit exceeded  
Power Supply Critical  
Power Supply Warning  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Configuring Platform Event Filters  
Interpreting Platform Event Traps  
Event Number [Note 1]  
Platform Event Description  
Discrete Power Supply Warning  
Power Supply Redundancy Lost  
Power Supply Redundancy Restored  
Power Supply Inserted  
525313  
527105  
527106  
552704  
552705  
552707  
786433  
080401h  
080B01h  
080B02h  
086F00h  
086F01h  
086F03h  
0C0001h  
Power Supply Failure  
Power Supply AC Lost  
Correctable ECC Memory Errors, Release 1.3(1) and later releases,  
filter set to accept all reading types [Note 4]  
786439  
0C0007h  
DDR3_INFO sensor LED - RED bit asserted (Probable ECC error on  
a DIMM), Generic Sensor [Notes 2,3]  
786689  
818945  
818951  
0C0101h  
0C7F01h  
0C7F07h  
Correctable ECC Memory Errors, Release 1.3(1) and later releases  
Correctable ECC Memory Errors, Release 1.2(x) and earlier releases  
DDR3_INFO sensor LED - RED bit asserted (Probable ECC error on  
a DIMM), 1.2(x) and earlier releases [Note 3]  
851968  
851972  
854016  
854017  
880384  
880385  
880512  
880513  
884480  
884481  
884482  
884483  
884484  
884485  
884486  
884487  
884488  
884489  
0D0000h  
0D0004h  
0D0800h  
0D0801h  
0D6F00h  
0D6F01h  
0D6F80h  
0D6F81h  
0D7F00h  
0D7F01h  
0D7F02h  
0D7F03h  
0D7F04h  
0D7F05h  
0D7F01h  
0D7F01h  
0D7F08h  
0D7F09h  
HDD sensor indicates no fault, Generic Sensor [Note 2]  
HDD sensor indicates a fault, Generic Sensor [Note 2]  
HDD Absent, Generic Sensor [Note 2]  
HDD Present, Generic Sensor [Note 2]  
HDD Present, no fault indicated  
HDD Fault  
HDD Not Present  
HDD is deasserted but not in a fault state  
Drive Slot LED Off  
Drive Slot LED On  
Drive Slot LED fast blink  
Drive Slot LED slow blink  
Drive Slot LED green  
Drive Slot LED amber  
Drive Slot LED blue  
Drive Slot LED read  
Drive Slot Online  
Drive Slot Degraded  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
154  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Platform Event Filters  
Interpreting Platform Event Traps  
Event Number [Note 1]  
Platform Event Description  
Note 1: Basic information about the event number format can be found in the IPMI Platform Event Trap  
Format Specification v1.0 at this URL: ftp://download.intel.com/design/servers/ipmi/pet100.pdf.  
Note 2: Some platforms and releases use generic sensor implementations, while some use Cisco proprietary  
sensor implementations.  
Note 3: In Release 1.3(1) and later releases, the ECC sensor no longer activates the LED.  
Note 4: When the event filter is set to accept all reading types, bits 15:8 of the hex event number are masked  
to 0. For example, event number 786689 (0C0101h) becomes 786433 (0C0001h).  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuring Platform Event Filters  
Interpreting Platform Event Traps  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
156  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
C H A P T E R  
13  
CIMC Firmware Management  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
•
•
Overview of Firmware  
C-Series servers use Cisco-certified firmware specific to the C-Series server model that you are using. You  
can download new releases of the firmware for all supported server models from Cisco.com.  
Caution  
When you install new BIOS firmware, it must be from the same software release as the CIMC firmware  
running on the server. Do not install new BIOS firmware until after you have activated the matching CIMC  
firmware or the server will not boot.  
To avoid potential problems, we strongly recommend that you use the Cisco Host Upgrade Utility (HUU),  
which upgrades the BIOS, CIMC, and other firmware to compatible levels. For detailed information about  
this utility, see the Cisco Host Upgrade Utility Guide for the version of the HUU that goes with the CIMC  
software release that you want to install. The HUU guides are available at the following URL: http://  
If you elect to update the firmware manually, you must update the CIMC firmware first. The CIMC firmware  
update process is divided into the following stages to minimize the amount of time the server will be offline:  
Installation. During this stage, CIMC installs the selected CIMC firmware in the non-active, or backup,  
slot on the server.  
•
Activation. During this stage, CIMC sets the non-active firmware version as active and reboots the  
server, causing a disruption in service. When the server reboots, the firmware in the new active slot  
becomes the running version.  
•
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
CIMC Firmware Management  
Obtaining Firmware from Cisco  
After you activate the CIMC firmware, you can update the BIOS firmware. The server must be powered off  
during the entire BIOS update process, so the process is not divided into stages. Instead, you only need to  
issue a single command and CIMC installs and updates the BIOS firmware as quickly as possible. Once the  
CIMC finishes rebooting, the server can be powered on and returned to service.  
Note  
You can either upgrade an older firmware version to a newer one, or downgrade a newer firmware version  
to an older one.  
Obtaining Firmware from Cisco  
Procedure  
Step 1  
Navigate to http://www.cisco.com/.  
Step 2 If you are not already logged in, click Log In at the top right-hand edge of the page and log in using your  
Cisco.com credentials.  
Step 3 In the menu bar at the top, click Support.  
Step 4 Click All Downloads in the roll down menu.  
Step 5 If your server model is listed in the Recently Used Products list, click the server name. Otherwise, do the  
following:  
a) In the left-hand box, click Products.  
b) In the center box, click Unified Computing and Servers.  
c) In the right-hand box, click Cisco UCS C-Series Rack-Mount Standalone Server Software.  
d) In the right-hand box, click the server model whose software you want to download.  
Step 6 Click the Unified Computing System (UCS) Server Firmware link.  
Step 7 (Optional) Select a prior release from the menu bar on the left-hand side of the page.  
Step 8 Click the Download button associated with the Cisco Host Upgrade Utility ISO for the selected release.  
Step 9 Click Accept License Agreement.  
Step 10 Save the ISO file to a local drive.  
We recommend you upgrade the CIMC and BIOS firmware on your server using this ISO file, which contains  
the Cisco Host Upgrade Utility. For detailed information about this utility, see the Cisco Host Upgrade Utility  
Guide for the version of the HUU that goes with the CIMC software release that you want to install. The HUU  
guides are available at the following URL: http://www.cisco.com/en/US/products/ps10493/products_user_  
Step 11 (Optional) If you plan to upgrade the CIMC and BIOS firmware manually, do the following:  
a) From the ISO file, open the ZIP file containing the firmware installation files.  
The ZIP file is on the top-level of the ISO file, and its name follows the format  
ServerModel_ReleaseNumber.ZIP.  
For example, C240M3_1.4.4A.ZIP.  
You do not need to extract all of the files contained in this ZIP file. Instead, you only need to open it so  
that you can access the BIOS firmware installation CAP file and the ZIP file containing the CIMC firmware  
installation BIN file.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
158  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
CIMC Firmware Management  
Installing CIMC Firmware from a Remote Server  
b) From the ServerModel_ReleaseNumber.ZIP file, extract the BIOS firmware installation CAP  
file and save it to your local drive.  
The CAP file is in the ReleaseNumber/bios/cimc folder, and its name follows the format  
Server-BIOS-Release-Number.CAP.  
For example, 1.4.4a/bios/cimc/C240-BIOS-1-4-4c-0.CAP.  
c) From the ServerModel_ReleaseNumber.ZIP file, open the ZIP file containing the CIMC firmware  
installation files.  
The ZIP file is in the ReleaseNumber/cimc folder and its name follows the format  
server-model-cimc-release.zip.  
For example, 1.4.4a/cimc/c240-m3-cimc.1.4.4a.zip.  
You do not need to extract all of the files contained in this zip file. Instead, you only need to open it so  
that you can access the CIMC firmware installation BIN file.  
d) From the server-model-cimc-release.zip file, extract the full CIMC firmware installation BIN  
file and save it to your local drive.  
The BIN file is in the server-model-cimc-release folder and its name follows the format  
upd-pkg-server-model-cimc.full.release.bin.  
For example, c240-m3-cimc.1.4.4a/upd-pkg-c240-m3-cimc.full.1.4.4a.bin.  
Step 12 (Optional) If you plan to install the firmware from a remote server, copy the BIOS installation CAP file and  
the CIMC installation BIN file to the remote server you want to use.  
The remote server can be one of the following:  
TFTP  
FTP  
•
•
•
•
•
SFTP  
SCP  
HTTP  
The server must have read permission for the destination folder on the remote server.  
What to Do Next  
Use the Cisco Host Upgrade Utility to upgrade all firmware on the server or manually install the CIMC  
firmware on the server.  
Installing CIMC Firmware from a Remote Server  
Before You Begin  
Log in to the as a user with admin privileges.  
•
•
Obtain the Cisco Host Upgrade Utility ISO file from Cisco.com and extract the firmware installation  
files as described in Obtaining Firmware from Cisco, on page 158.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
CIMC Firmware Management  
Activating Installed CIMC Firmware  
Note  
If you start an update while an update is already in process, both updates will fail.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Server /cimc # scope firmware  
Enters the CIMC firmware command mode.  
Server /cimc/firmware # update  
protocol IP Address path  
Specifies the protocol, IP address of the remote server  
and the file path to the firmware file on the server. The  
protocol can be one of the following:  
TFTP  
FTP  
•
•
•
•
•
SFTP  
SCP  
HTTP  
Step 4  
Server /cimc/firmware # show detail (Optional)  
Displays the progress of the firmware update.  
This example updates the CIMC firmware:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope firmware  
Server /cimc/firmware # update ftp 192.0.20.34 //test/dnld-ucs-k9-bundle.1.0.2h.bin  
<CR> Press Enter key  
Firmware update has started.  
Please check the status using "show detail"  
Server /cimc/firmware #  
What to Do Next  
Activate the new firmware.  
Activating Installed CIMC Firmware  
Before You Begin  
Install the CIMC firmware on the server.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
160  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
CIMC Firmware Management  
Activating Installed CIMC Firmware  
Important  
While the activation is in progress, do not:  
Reset, power off, or shut down the server.  
Reboot or reset CIMC.  
•
•
•
•
Activate any other firmware.  
Export technical support or configuration data.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Enters the firmware command mode.  
Server /cimc # scope firmware  
Server /cimc/firmware # show detail  
Displays the available firmware images and  
status.  
Step 4  
Server /cimc/firmware # activate [1 | 2] Activates the selected image. If no image number  
is specified, the server activates the currently  
inactive image.  
Step 5  
Step 6  
At the prompt, enter y to activate the  
selected firmware image.  
The BMC reboots, terminating all CLI and GUI  
sessions until the reboot completes.  
(Optional)  
Log back into the CLI and repeat steps 1–3  
to verify the activation.  
This example activates firmware image 1 and then verifies the activation after the BMC reboots:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope firmware  
Server /cimc/firmware # show detail  
Firmware Image Information:  
Update Stage: NONE  
Update Progress: 100  
Current FW Version: 1.3(3a)  
FW Image 1 Version: 1.4(3j)  
FW Image 1 State: BACKUP INACTIVATED  
FW Image 2 Version: 1.3(3a)  
FW Image 2 State: RUNNING ACTIVATED  
Boot-loader Version: 1.4(3.21).18  
Server /cimc/firmware # activate 1  
This operation will activate firmware 1 and reboot the BMC.  
Continue?[y|N]y  
.
.
-- BMC reboot --  
.
.
-- Log into CLI as Admin --  
Server# scope cimc  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CIMC Firmware Management  
Installing BIOS Firmware from a Remote Server  
Server /cimc # scope firmware  
Server /cimc/firmware # show detail  
Firmware Image Information:  
Update Stage: NONE  
Update Progress: 100  
Current FW Version: 1.4(3j)  
FW Image 1 Version: 1.4(3j)  
FW Image 1 State: RUNNING ACTIVATED  
FW Image 2 Version: 1.3(3a)  
FW Image 2 State: BACKUP INACTIVATED  
Boot-loader Version: 1.4(3.21).18  
Installing BIOS Firmware from a Remote Server  
Note  
This procedure is not available on some servers. For other BIOS installation methods, see the Cisco UCS  
C-Series Rack-Mount Server BIOS Upgrade Guide available at the following URL: http://www.cisco.com/  
Before You Begin  
Log in to the as a user with admin privileges.  
•
•
•
Activate the CIMC firmware that goes with the BIOS version you want to install, as described in .  
Power off the server.  
Note  
If you start an update while an update is already in process, both updates will fail.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Step 4  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Server /cimc # scope firmware  
Enters the firmware command mode.  
Server /cimc/firmware # show detail Displays the available firmware images and status.  
Make sure the firmware version shown Important  
in the Current FW Version field  
matches the BIOS firmware version you  
are installing.  
If the CIMC firmware version does not  
match, activate the CIMC firmware  
before continuing with this procedure  
or the server will not boot. For details,  
Firmware, on page 160.  
Step 5  
Step 6  
Server /cimc/firmware # top  
Server# scope bios  
Returns to the server root level.  
Enters the BIOS command mode.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
162  
OL-28893-01  
   
CIMC Firmware Management  
Installing BIOS Firmware from a Remote Server  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 7  
Server /bios # update protocol  
Specifies the protocol to be used. It can be TFTP,  
FTP, SFTP, SCP or HTTP.  
Step 8  
Step 9  
Server /bios # update IP Address  
Server /bios # update path  
Specifies the IP address or the host name of the  
remote server.  
Specifies the file path to the BIOS firmware file on  
the remote server.  
This example updates the BIOS firmware to CIMC software release 1.4(3j):  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope firmware  
Server /cimc/firmware # show detail  
Firmware Image Information:  
Update Stage: NONE  
Update Progress: 100  
Current FW Version: 1.4(3j)  
FW Image 1 Version: 1.4(3j)  
FW Image 1 State: RUNNING ACTIVATED  
FW Image 2 Version: 1.3(3a)  
FW Image 2 State: BACKUP INACTIVATED  
Boot-loader Version: 1.4(3.21).18  
Server /cimc/firmware # top  
Server # scope bios  
Server /bios # update ftp 192.0.20.34 //upgrade_bios_files/C260-BIOS-1-4-3j-0.CAP  
<CR> Press Enter key  
Firmware update has started.  
Please check the status using "show detail"  
Server /bios #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CIMC Firmware Management  
Installing BIOS Firmware from a Remote Server  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
164  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
C H A P T E R  
14  
Viewing Logs  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
Viewing the Faults and Logs Summary  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server # scope fault  
Enters fault command mode.  
Displays a log of all the faults.  
Server # show fault-entries  
This example displays a summary of faults:  
Server # scope fault  
Server /fault # show fault-entries  
Time  
Severity  
Description  
------------------------ ------------ -----------------  
Sun Jun 27 04:00:52 2013 info  
Sat Jun 26 05:00:22 2013 warning  
Storage Local disk 12 missing  
Power Supply redundancy is lost  
Server /fault #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Viewing Logs  
CIMC Log  
CIMC Log  
Viewing the CIMC Log  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Server /cimc # scope log  
Enters the CIMC log command mode.  
Server /cimc/log # show entries  
[detail]  
Displays CIMC events, including timestamp, the  
software module that logged the event, and a  
description of the event.  
This example displays the log of CIMC events:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope log  
Server /cimc/log # show entries  
Time  
Severity  
Source  
Description  
------------------- ------------- ---------------- ----------------------------------------  
2012 Jan 30 05:20:45 Informational BMC:ciscoNET:961 " rpc_aim_callback_function_1_svc() -  
result == SUCCESS, callbackData size: 600 "  
2012 Jan 30 05:20:45 Informational BMC:ciscoNET:961 rpc_aim_callback_function_1_svc() -  
returned from pFunctionCallback result:0  
2012 Jan 30 05:20:45 Informational BMC:ciscoNET:961 " rpc_aim_callback_function_1_svc() -  
szFunctionName:netGetCurrentIfConfig nSize:0 nMaxSize: 600 "  
--More--  
Server /cimc/log # show entries detail  
Trace Log:  
Time: 2012 Jan 30 05:20:45  
Severity: Informational  
Source: BMC:ciscoNET:961  
Description: " rpc_aim_callback_function_1_svc() - result == SUCCESS, callbackData size:  
600 "  
Order: 0  
Trace Log:  
Time: 2012 Jan 30 05:20:45  
Severity: Informational  
Source: BMC:ciscoNET:961  
Description: rpc_aim_callback_function_1_svc() - returned from pFunctionCallback result:0  
Order: 1  
Trace Log:  
Time: 2012 Jan 30 05:20:45  
Severity: Informational  
Source: BMC:ciscoNET:961  
Description: " rpc_aim_callback_function_1_svc() - szFunctionName:netGetCurrentIfConfig  
nSize:0 nMaxSize: 600 "  
Order: 2  
--More--  
Server /cimc/log #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
166  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Viewing Logs  
Clearing the CIMC Log  
Clearing the CIMC Log  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Enters the CIMC log command mode.  
Clears the CIMC log.  
Server /cimc # scope log  
Server /cimc/log # clear  
The following example clears the log of CIMC events:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope log  
Server /cimc/log # clear  
Configuring the CIMC Log Threshold  
You can specify the lowest level of messages that will be included in the CIMC log.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Server /cimc # scope log  
Enters the CIMC log command mode.  
Server /cimc/log # set  
The severity level can be one of the following, in decreasing  
local-syslog-severity level  
order of severity:  
emergency  
alert  
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
critical  
error  
warning  
notice  
informational  
debug  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Viewing Logs  
Sending the CIMC Log to a Remote Server  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Note  
CIMC does not log any messages with a severity  
below the selected severity. For example, if you  
select error, then the CIMC log will contain all  
messages with the severity Emergency, Alert,  
Critical, or Error. It will not show Warning, Notice,  
Informational, or Debug messages.  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /cimc/log # commit  
Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
Server /cimc/log # show  
(Optional)  
local-syslog-severity  
Displays the configured severity level.  
This example shows how to configure the logging of messages with a minimum severity of Warning:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope log  
Server /cimc/log # set local-syslog-severity warning  
Server /cimc/log *# commit  
Server /cimc/log # show local-syslog-severity  
Local Syslog Severity: warning  
Server /cimc/log #  
Sending the CIMC Log to a Remote Server  
You can configure profiles for one or two remote syslog servers to receive CIMC log entries.  
Before You Begin  
The remote syslog server must be configured to receive logs from a remote host.  
•
•
The remote syslog server must be configured to receive all types of logs, including authentication-related  
logs.  
The remote syslog server's firewall must be configured to allow syslog messages to reach the syslog  
server.  
•
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Server /cimc # scope log  
Enters the CIMC log command mode.  
Server /cimc/log # set  
(Optional)  
remote-syslog-severity level  
The severity level can be one of the following, in decreasing  
order of severity:  
emergency  
alert  
•
•
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
168  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Viewing Logs  
Sending the CIMC Log to a Remote Server  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
critical  
•
•
•
•
•
•
error  
warning  
notice  
informational  
debug  
Note  
CIMC does not remotely log any messages with a  
severity below the selected severity. For example,  
if you select error, then the remote syslog server  
will receive all CIMC log messages with the  
severity Emergency, Alert, Critical, or Error. It will  
not show Warning, Notice, Informational, or Debug  
messages.  
Step 4  
Server /cimc/log # scope server Selects one of the two remote syslog server profiles and  
{1 | 2}  
enters the command mode for configuring the profile.  
Step 5  
Step 6  
Server /cimc/log/server # set  
server-ip ip-address  
Specifies the remote syslog server IP address.  
Server /cimc/log/server # set  
enabled {yes | no}  
Enables the sending of CIMC log entries to this syslog  
server.  
Step 7  
Server /cimc/log/server # commit Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
This example shows how to configure a remote syslog server profile and enable the sending of CIMC log  
entries with a minimum severity level of Warning:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope log  
Server /cimc/log # set remote-syslog-severity warning  
Server /cimc/log *# scope server 2  
Server /cimc/log/server *# set server-ip 192.0.2.34  
Server /cimc/log/server *# set enabled yes  
Server /cimc/log/server *# commit  
Server /cimc/log/server # exit  
Server /cimc/log # show server  
Syslog Server  
IP Address  
Enabled  
---------------- ---------------- --------  
1
2
0.0.0.0  
192.0.2.34  
no  
yes  
Server /cimc/log # show remote-syslog-severity  
Remote Syslog Severity: warning  
Server /cimc/log #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Viewing Logs  
System Event Log  
System Event Log  
Viewing the System Event Log  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope sel  
Enters the system event log (SEL) command mode.  
Server /sel # show entries  
[detail]  
For system events, displays timestamp, the severity of the  
event, and a description of the event. The detail keyword  
displays the information in a list format instead of a table  
format.  
This example displays the system event log:  
Server# scope sel  
Server /sel # show entries  
Time  
Severity  
Description  
------------------- ------------- ----------------------------------------  
[System Boot]  
Informational " LED_PSU_STATUS: Platform sensor, OFF event was asserted"  
[System Boot]  
[System Boot]  
was asserted"  
[System Boot]  
Informational " LED_HLTH_STATUS: Platform sensor, GREEN was asserted"  
Normal  
Normal  
" PSU_REDUNDANCY: PS Redundancy sensor, Fully Redundant  
" PSU2 PSU2_STATUS: Power Supply sensor for PSU2, Power  
Supply input lost (AC/DC) was deasserted"  
[System Boot]  
Informational " LED_PSU_STATUS: Platform sensor, ON event was asserted"  
[System Boot]  
[System Boot]  
was asserted"  
[System Boot]  
Informational " LED_HLTH_STATUS: Platform sensor, AMBER was asserted"  
Critical  
Critical  
" PSU_REDUNDANCY: PS Redundancy sensor, Redundancy Lost  
" PSU2 PSU2_STATUS: Power Supply sensor for PSU2, Power  
Supply input lost (AC/DC) was asserted"  
[System Boot]  
asserted"  
[System Boot]  
deasserted"  
[System Boot]  
Normal  
" HDD_01_STATUS: Drive Slot sensor, Drive Presence was  
Critical  
" HDD_01_STATUS: Drive Slot sensor, Drive Presence was  
Informational " DDR3_P2_D1_INFO: Memory sensor, OFF event was asserted"  
2001-01-01 08:30:16 Warning  
was deasserted"  
2001-01-01 08:30:16 Critical  
event was deasserted"  
" PSU2 PSU2_VOUT: Voltage sensor for PSU2, failure event  
" PSU2 PSU2_VOUT: Voltage sensor for PSU2, non-recoverable  
2001-01-01 08:30:15 Informational " LED_PSU_STATUS: Platform sensor, ON event was asserted"  
2001-01-01 08:30:15 Informational " LED_HLTH_STATUS: Platform sensor, AMBER was asserted"  
2001-01-01 08:30:15 Informational " LED_HLTH_STATUS: Platform sensor, FAST BLINK event was  
asserted"  
2001-01-01 08:30:14 Non-Recoverable " PSU2 PSU2_VOUT: Voltage sensor for PSU2, non-recoverable  
event was asserted"  
2001-01-01 08:30:14 Critical  
was asserted"  
--More--  
" PSU2 PSU2_VOUT: Voltage sensor for PSU2, failure event  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
170  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Viewing Logs  
Clearing the System Event Log  
Clearing the System Event Log  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope sel  
Server /sel # clear  
Enters the system event log command mode.  
You are prompted to confirm the action. If you enter y  
at the prompt, the system event log is cleared.  
This example clears the system event log:  
Server# scope sel  
Server /sel # clear  
This operation will clear the whole sel.  
Continue?[y|N]y  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Viewing Logs  
Clearing the System Event Log  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
172  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
C H A P T E R  
15  
Server Utilities  
This chapter includes the following sections:  
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Exporting Technical Support Data  
Perform this task when requested by the Cisco Technical Assistance Center (TAC). This utility creates a  
summary report containing configuration information, logs and diagnostic data that will help TAC in  
troubleshooting and resolving a technical issue.  
Important  
If any firmware or BIOS updates are in progress, do not export the technical support data until those tasks  
are complete.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Server /cimc # scope tech-support Enters the tech-support command mode.  
Server /cimc/tech-support # set  
remote-ip ip-address  
Specifies the IP address of the remote server on which  
the technical support data file should be stored.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OL-28893-01  
173  
       
Server Utilities  
Exporting Technical Support Data  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 4  
Step 5  
Server /cimc/tech-support # set  
remote-path path/filename  
Specifies the file name in which the support data should  
be stored on the remote server. When you enter this name,  
include the relative path for the file from the top of the  
server tree to the desired location.  
Tip  
To have the system auto-generate the file name,  
enter the file name as default.tar.gz.  
Server /cimc/tech-support # set  
remote-protocol protocol  
Specifies the protocol to connect to the remote server. It  
can be of the following types:  
tftp  
ftp  
•
•
•
•
•
sftp  
scp  
http  
Step 6  
Step 7  
Server /cimc/tech-support # set  
remote-username name  
Specifies the user name on the remote server on which  
the technical support data file should be stored. This field  
does not apply if the protocol is TFTP or HTTP.  
Server /cimc/tech-support # set  
remote-password password  
Specifies the password on the remote server on which  
the technical support data file should be stored. This field  
does not apply if the protocol is TFTP or HTTP.  
Step 8  
Step 9  
Step 10  
Server /cimc/tech-support # commit Commits the transaction to the system configuration.  
Server /cimc/tech-support # start Begins the transfer of the data file to the remote server.  
Server /cimc/tech-support # show (Optional)  
detail  
Displays the progress of the transfer of the data file to  
the remote server.  
Step 11  
Server /cimc/tech-support # cancel (Optional)  
Cancels the transfer of the data file to the remote server.  
This example creates a technical support data file and transfers the file to a TFTP server:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope tech-support  
Server /cimc/tech-support # set remote-ip 192.0.20.41  
Server /cimc/tech-support* # set remote-protocol tftp  
Server /cimc/tech-support *# set remote-path /user/user1/default.tar.gz  
Server /cimc/tech-support *# commit  
Server /cimc/tech-support # start  
Tech Support upload started.  
Server /cimc/tech-support # show detail  
Tech Support:  
Server Address: 192.0.20.41  
Path: default.tar.gz  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
174  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Server Utilities  
Rebooting the CIMC  
Protocol: tftp  
Username:  
Password: *******  
Progress (%): 5  
Status: Collecting  
Server /cimc/tech-support #  
What to Do Next  
Provide the generated report file to Cisco TAC.  
Rebooting the CIMC  
On rare occasions, such as an issue with the current running firmware, troubleshooting a server may require  
you to reboot the CIMC. This procedure is not part of the normal maintenance of a server. After you reboot  
the CIMC, you are logged off and the CIMC will be unavailable for a few minutes.  
Note  
If you reboot the CIMC while the server is performing power-on self test (POST) or is operating in the  
Extensible Firmware Interface (EFI) shell, the server will be powered down until the CIMC reboot is  
complete.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Server /cimc # reboot  
The CIMC reboots.  
This example reboots the CIMC:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # reboot  
Clearing the BIOS CMOS  
On rare occasions, troubleshooting a server may require you to clear the server's BIOS CMOS memory. This  
procedure is not part of the normal maintenance of a server.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Server# scope bios  
Enters the bios command mode.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Server Utilities  
Recovering from a Corrupted BIOS  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 2  
Server /bios # clear-cmos  
After a prompt to confirm, clears the CMOS  
memory.  
This example clears the BIOS CMOS memory:  
Server# scope bios  
Server /bios # clear-cmos  
This operation will clear the BIOS CMOS.  
Note: Server should be in powered off state to clear CMOS.  
Continue?[y|n] y  
Server /bios #  
Recovering from a Corrupted BIOS  
Note  
This procedure is not available in some server models.  
In addition to this procedure, there are three other methods for recovering from a corrupted BIOS:  
Use the Cisco Host Upgrade Utility (HUU). This is the recommended method.  
Use the CIMC GUI interface.  
•
•
•
If your server model supports it, use the BIOS recovery function of the hardware jumper on the server  
motherboard. For instructions, see the Cisco UCS Server Installation and Service Guide for your server  
model.  
Before You Begin  
You must be logged in as admin to recover from a corrupted BIOS.  
•
•
Have the BIOS recovery ISO image ready. You will find the BIOS recovery ISO image under the  
Recovery folder of the firmware distribution package.  
Schedule some down time for the server because it will be power cycled at the end of the recovery  
procedure.  
•
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope bios  
Enters the bios command mode.  
Server# recover  
Launches a dialog for loading the BIOS recovery  
image.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
176  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Server Utilities  
Resetting the CIMC to Factory Defaults  
This example shows how to recover from a corrupted BIOS:  
Server# scope bios  
Server /bios # recover  
This operation will automatically power on the server to perform BIOS FW recovery.  
Continue?[y|N]y  
What to Do Next  
Power cycle or reset the server.  
Resetting the CIMC to Factory Defaults  
On rare occasions, such as an issue with the current running firmware, troubleshooting a server may require  
you to reset the CIMC to the factory default. When this happens, all user-configurable settings are reset.  
This procedure is not part of the normal server maintenance. After you reset the CIMC, you are logged off  
and must log in again. You may also lose connectivity and may need to reconfigure the network settings.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Server /cimc # factory-default  
After a prompt to confirm, the CIMC resets to  
factory defaults.  
The CIMC factory defaults include the following conditions:  
SSH is enabled for access to the CIMC CLI. Telnet is disabled.  
HTTPS is enabled for access to the CIMC GUI.  
A single user account exists (user name is admin , password is password ).  
DHCP is enabled on the management port.  
The boot order is EFI, CDROM, PXE (using LoM), FDD, HDD.  
KVM and vMedia are enabled.  
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
USB is enabled.  
SoL is disabled.  
This example resets the CIMC to factory defaults:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # factory-default  
This operation will reset the CIMC configuration to factory default.  
All your configuration will be lost.  
Continue?[y|N]  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Server Utilities  
Exporting and Importing the CIMC Configuration  
Exporting and Importing the CIMC Configuration  
Exporting and Importing the CIMC Configuration  
To perform a backup of the CIMC configuration, you take a snapshot of the system configuration and export  
the resulting CIMC configuration file to a location on your network. The export operation saves information  
from the management plane only; it does not back up data on the servers. Sensitive configuration information  
such as user accounts and the server certificate are not exported.  
You can restore an exported CIMC configuration file to the same system or you can import it to another CIMC  
system, provided that the software version of the importing system is the same as or is configuration-compatible  
with the software version of the exporting system. When you import a configuration file to another system  
as a configuration template, you must modify system-specific settings such as IP addresses and host names.  
An import operation modifies information on the management plane only.  
The CIMC configuration file is an XML text file whose structure and elements correspond to the CIMC  
command modes.  
When performing an export or import operation, consider these guidelines:  
You can perform an export or an import while the system is up and running. While an export operation  
has no impact on the server or network traffic, some modifications caused by an import operation, such  
as IP address changes, can disrupt traffic or cause a server reboot.  
•
•
You cannot execute an export and an import simultaneously.  
Exporting the CIMC Configuration  
Note  
For security reasons, this operation does not export user accounts or the server certificate.  
Important  
If any firmware or BIOS updates are in progress, do not export the CIMC configuration until those tasks  
are complete.  
Before You Begin  
Obtain the backup remote server IP address.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Server /cimc # scope import-export Enters the import-export command mode.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
178  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Server Utilities  
Importing a CIMC Configuration  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 3  
Server /cimc/import-export #  
export-config protocol ip-address  
path-and-filename  
Starts the backup operation. The configuration file will  
be stored at the specified path and file name on a remote  
server at the specified IP address. The remote server  
could be one of the following types:  
TFTP  
FTP  
•
•
•
•
•
SFTP  
SCP  
HTTP  
To determine whether the export operation has completed successfully, use the show detail command. To  
abort the operation, type CTRL+C.  
This example shows how to back up the CIMC configuration:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope import-export  
Server /cimc/import-export # export-config tftp 192.0.2.34 /ucs/backups/cimc5.xml  
Export config started. Please check the status using "show detail".  
Server /cimc/import-export # show detail  
Import Export:  
Operation: EXPORT  
Status: COMPLETED  
Error Code: 100 (No Error)  
Diagnostic Message: NONE  
Server /cimc/import-export #  
Importing a CIMC Configuration  
Important  
If any firmware or BIOS updates are in progress, do not import the CIMC configuration until those tasks  
are complete.  
Before You Begin  
If you want to restore the SNMP configuration information when you import the configuration file, make sure  
that SNMP is disabled on this server before you do the import. If SNMP is enabled when you perform the  
import, CIMC does not overwrite the current values with those saved in the configuration file.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Server# scope cimc  
Enters the CIMC command mode.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Server Utilities  
Generating Non maskable Interrupts to the Host  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 2  
Step 3  
Server /cimc # scope import-export Enters the import-export command mode.  
Server /cimc/import-export #  
import-config protocol ip-address  
path-and-filename  
Starts the import operation. The configuration file at  
the specified path and file name on the remote server  
at the specified IP address will be imported. The remote  
server can be one of the following:  
TFTP  
FTP  
•
•
•
•
•
SFTP  
SCP  
HTTP  
To determine whether the import operation has completed successfully, use the show detail command. To  
abort the operation, type CTRL+C.  
This example shows how to import a CIMC configuration:  
Server# scope cimc  
Server /cimc # scope import-export  
Server /cimc/import-export # import-config tftp 192.0.2.34 /ucs/backups/cimc5.xml  
Import config started. Please check the status using "show detail".  
Server /cimc/import-export #  
Generating Non maskable Interrupts to the Host  
In some situations, the server might hang and not respond to traditional debug mechanisms. By generating a  
non maskable interrupt (NMI) to the host, you can create and send a crash dump file of the server and use it  
to debug the server.  
Depending on the type of operating system associated with the server, this task might restart the OS.  
Procedure  
Command or Action  
Purpose  
Step 1  
Step 2  
Server # scope chassis  
Enters chassis command mode.  
Server /chassis # generate-nmi  
Generates the crash dump file for the server.  
To use this command, the server must be powered on,  
and you must be logged in as an administrator.  
This example shows how to generate NMI signals to the host:  
Server # scope chassis  
Server /chassis # generate-nmi  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
180  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Server Utilities  
Generating Non maskable Interrupts to the Host  
This operation will send NMI to the host and may cause reboot of the OS.  
OS reboot depends on it's NMI configuration.  
Do you want to continue? [y|N] y  
Server /chassis #  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OL-28893-01  
181  
Server Utilities  
Generating Non maskable Interrupts to the Host  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
182  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A P P E N D I X  
A
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
This appendix contains the following sections:  
•
•
•
•
•
C22 and C24 Servers  
Main BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Name  
Description  
TPM Support  
TPM (Trusted Platform Module) is a microchip designed to provide  
basic security-related functions primarily involving encryption keys.  
This option allows you to control the TPM Security Device support for  
the system. It can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The server does not use the TPM.  
• Enabled—The server uses the TPM.  
Note  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Processor Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Intel Hyper-Threading Technology  
Whether the processor uses Intel Hyper-Threading Technology,  
which allows multithreaded software applications to execute  
threads in parallel within each processor. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not permit hyperthreading.  
• Enabled—The processor allows for the parallel execution  
of multiple threads.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Number of Enabled Cores  
Allows you to disable one or more of the physical cores on the  
server. This can be one of the following:  
• All—Enables all physical cores. This also enables Hyper  
Threading on the associated logical processor cores.  
• 1 through n—Specifies the number of physical processor  
cores that can run on the server. Each physical core has  
an associated logical core.  
To disable Hyper Threading and have only one logical  
processor core running on the server, select 1.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Execute Disable  
Classifies memory areas on the server to specify where  
application code can execute. As a result of this classification,  
the processor disables code execution if a malicious worm  
attempts to insert code in the buffer. This setting helps to prevent  
damage, worm propagation, and certain classes of malicious  
buffer overflow attacks. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not classify memory areas.  
• Enabled—The processor classifies memory areas.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
184  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Intel VT  
Whether the processor uses Intel Virtualization Technology  
(VT), which allows a platform to run multiple operating systems  
and applications in independent partitions. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not permit virtualization.  
• Enabled—The processor allows multiple operating  
systems in independent partitions.  
Note  
If you change this option, you must power cycle the  
server before the setting takes effect.  
Intel VT-d  
Whether the processor uses Intel Virtualization Technology for  
Directed I/O (VT-d). This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not use virtualization  
technology.  
• Enabled—The processor uses virtualization technology.  
Intel VT-d Coherency Support  
Whether the processor supports Intel VT-d Coherency. This can  
be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not support coherency.  
• Enabled—The processor uses VT-d Coherency as  
required.  
Intel VT-d ATS Support  
Whether the processor supports Intel VT-d Address Translation  
Services (ATS). This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not support ATS.  
• Enabled—The processor uses VT-d ATS as required.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Name  
Description  
CPU Performance  
Sets the CPU performance profile for the server. The  
performance profile consists of the following options:  
Data Reuse Optimization  
DCU Streamer Prefetcher  
DCU IP Prefetcher  
•
•
•
•
•
Hardware Prefetcher  
Adjacent Cache-Line Prefetch  
This can be one of the following:  
• Enterprise—Only the DCU IP Prefetcher is enabled. The  
rest of the options are disabled.  
• —All options are enabled.  
• HPC—Data Reuse Optimization is disabled and all other  
options are enabled. This setting is also known as high  
performance computing.  
• Custom—All performance profile options can be  
configured from the BIOS setup on the server. In addition,  
the Hardware Prefetcher and Adjacent Cache-Line Prefetch  
options can be configured in the fields below.  
Hardware Prefetcher  
Whether the processor allows the Intel hardware prefetcher to  
fetch streams of data and instruction from memory into the  
unified second-level cache when necessary. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The hardware prefetcher is not used.  
• Enabled—The processor uses the hardware prefetcher  
when cache issues are detected.  
Adjacent Cache Line Prefetcher  
Whether the processor fetches cache lines in even/odd pairs  
instead of fetching just the required line. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The processor only fetches the required line.  
• Enabled— The processor fetches both the required line  
and its paired line.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
186  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Name  
Description  
DCU Streamer Prefetch  
Whether the processor uses the DCU IP Prefetch mechanism to  
analyze historical cache access patterns and preload the most  
relevant lines in the L1 cache. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not try to anticipate cache  
read requirements and only fetches explicitly requested  
lines.  
• Enabled—The DCU prefetcher analyzes the cache read  
pattern and prefetches the next line in the cache if it  
determines that it may be needed.  
DCU IP Prefetcher  
Whether the processor uses the DCU IP Prefetch mechanism to  
analyze historical cache access patterns and preload the most  
relevant lines in the L1 cache. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not preload any cache data.  
• Enabled—The DCU IP prefetcher preloads the L1 cache  
with the data it determines to be the most relevant.  
Direct Cache Access Support  
Allows processors to increase I/O performance by placing data  
from I/O devices directly into the processor cache. This setting  
helps to reduce cache misses. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Data from I/O devices is not placed directly  
into the processor cache.  
• Enabled—Data from I/O devices is placed directly into  
the processor cache.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Power Technology  
Enables you to configure the CPU power management settings  
for the following options:  
Enhanced Intel Speedstep Technology  
Intel Turbo Boost Technology  
Processor Power State C6  
•
•
•
Power Technology can be one of the following:  
• Custom—The server uses the individual settings for the  
BIOS parameters mentioned above. You must select this  
option if you want to change any of these BIOS  
parameters.  
• Disabled—The server does not perform any CPU power  
management and any settings for the BIOS parameters  
mentioned above are ignored.  
• —The server determines the best settings for the BIOS  
parameters mentioned above and ignores the individual  
settings for these parameters.  
Enhanced Intel Speedstep Technology Whether the processor uses Enhanced Intel SpeedStep  
Technology, which allows the system to dynamically adjust  
processor voltage and core frequency. This technology can result  
in decreased average power consumption and decreased average  
heat production. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor never dynamically adjusts its  
voltage or frequency.  
• Enabled—The processor utilizes Enhanced Intel  
SpeedStep Technology and enables all supported processor  
sleep states to further conserve power.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Note  
must be set to Custom or the server ignores the setting  
for this parameter.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
188  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Intel Turbo Boost Technology  
Whether the processor uses Intel Turbo Boost Technology,  
which allows the processor to automatically increase its  
frequency if it is running below power, temperature, or voltage  
specifications. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not increase its frequency  
automatically.  
• Enabled—The processor utilizes Turbo Boost Technology  
if required.  
Note  
must be set to Custom or the server ignores the setting  
for this parameter.  
Processor Power State C6  
Whether the BIOS sends the C6 report to the operating system.  
When the OS receives the report, it can transition the processor  
into the lower C6 power state to decrease energy usage while  
maintaining optimal processor performance. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not send the C6 report.  
• Enabled—The BIOS sends the C6 report, allowing the  
OS to transition the processor to the C6 low power state.  
Note  
must be set to Custom or the server ignores the setting  
for this parameter.  
Processor Power State C1 Enhanced  
Whether the CPU transitions to its minimum frequency when  
entering the C1 state. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The CPU continues to run at its maximum  
frequency in C1 state.  
• Enabled—The CPU transitions to its minimum frequency.  
This option saves the maximum amount of power in C1  
state.  
Frequency Floor Override  
Whether the CPU is allowed to drop below the maximum  
non-turbo frequency when idle. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled— The CPU can drop below the maximum  
non-turbo frequency when idle. This option decreases  
power consumption but may reduce system performance.  
• Enabled— The CPU cannot drop below the maximum  
non-turbo frequency when idle. This option improves  
system performance but may increase power consumption.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Name  
Description  
P-STATE Coordination  
Allows you to define how BIOS communicates the P-state  
support model to the operating system. There are 3 models as  
defined by the Advanced Configuration and Power Interface  
(ACPI) specification.  
• HW_ALL—The processor hardware is responsible for  
coordinating the P-state among logical processors with  
dependencies (all logical processors in a package).  
• SW_ALL—The OS Power Manager (OSPM) is  
responsible for coordinating the P-state among logical  
processors with dependencies (all logical processors in a  
physical package), and must initiate the transition on all  
of the logical processors.  
• SW_ANY—The OS Power Manager (OSPM) is  
responsible for coordinating the P-state among logical  
processors with dependencies (all logical processors in a  
package), and may initiate the transition on any of the  
logical processors in the domain.  
Note  
must be set to Custom or the server ignores the setting  
for this parameter.  
Allows you to determine whether system performance or energy  
efficiency is more important on this server. This can be one of  
the following:  
•
•
•
•
must be set to Custom or the  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Memory Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Select Memory RAS  
How the memory reliability, availability, and serviceability  
(RAS) is configured for the server. This can be one of the  
following:  
• —System performance is optimized.  
• Mirroring—System reliability is optimized by using half  
the system memory as backup.  
• Lockstep—If the DIMM pairs in the server have an  
identical type, size, and organization and are populated  
across the SMI channels, you can enable lockstep mode  
to minimize memory access latency and provide better  
performance. This option offers better system performance  
than Mirroring and better reliability than Maximum  
Performance but lower reliability than Mirroring and lower  
system performance than Maximum Performance.  
DRAM Clock Throttling  
Allows you to determine whether memory bandwidth or system  
performance is more important on this server. This can be one  
of the following:  
• Balanced— DRAM clock throttling is reduced, providing  
a balance between performance and power.  
• Performance—DRAM clock throttling is disabled,  
providing increased memory bandwidth at the cost of  
additional power.  
• —DRAM clock throttling is increased to improve energy  
efficiency.  
NUMA  
Whether the BIOS supports NUMA. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not support NUMA.  
• Enabled—The BIOS includes the ACPI tables that are  
required for NUMA-aware operating systems. If you  
enable this option, the system must disable Inter-Socket  
Memory interleaving on some platforms.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Low Voltage DDR Mode  
Whether the system prioritizes low voltage or high frequency  
memory operations. This can be one of the following:  
• —The system prioritizes low voltage memory operations  
over high frequency memory operations. This mode may  
lower memory frequency in order to keep the voltage low.  
• —The system prioritizes high frequency operations over  
low voltage operations.  
DRAM Refresh rate  
Allows you to set the rate at which the DRAM cells are  
refreshed. This can be one of the following:  
• 1x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 64ms.  
• 2x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 32ms.  
• 3x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 21ms.  
• 4x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 16ms.  
Channel Interleaving  
Whether the CPU divides memory blocks and spreads  
contiguous portions of data across interleaved channels to enable  
simultaneous read operations. This can be one of the following:  
• Auto—The CPU determines what interleaving is done.  
• —Some channel interleaving is used.  
•
•
• —The maximum amount of channel interleaving is used.  
Rank Interleaving  
Whether the CPU interleaves physical ranks of memory so that  
one rank can be accessed while another is being refreshed. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Auto—The CPU determines what interleaving is done.  
• —Some rank interleaving is used.  
•
•
• —The maximum amount of rank interleaving is used.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
192  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Patrol Scrub  
Whether the system actively searches for, and corrects, single  
bit memory errors even in unused portions of the memory on  
the server. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The system checks for memory ECC errors  
only when the CPU reads or writes a memory address.  
• Enabled—The system periodically reads and writes  
memory searching for ECC errors. If any errors are found,  
the system attempts to fix them. This option may correct  
single bit errors before they become multi-bit errors, but  
it may adversely affect performance when the patrol scrub  
is running.  
Demand Scrub  
Whether the system corrects single bit memory errors  
encountered when the CPU or I/O makes a demand read. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Disabled— Single bit memory errors are not corrected.  
• Enabled— Single bit memory errors are corrected in  
memory and the corrected data is set in response to the  
demand read.  
Altitude  
The approximate number of meters above sea level at which the  
physical server is installed. This can be one of the following:  
• Auto—The CPU determines the physical elevation.  
• —The server is approximately 300 meters above sea level.  
• —The server is approximately 900 meters above sea level.  
• —The server is approximately 1500 meters above sea  
level.  
• —The server is approximately 3000 meters above sea  
level.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
QPI Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
QPI Link Frequency  
The Intel QuickPath Interconnect (QPI) link frequency, in gigatransfers  
per second (GT/s). This can be one of the following:  
• Auto—The CPU determines the QPI link frequency.  
•
•
•
Onboard Storage Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Onboard SCU Storage Support Whether the onboard software RAID controller is available to the server.  
This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The software RAID controller is not available.  
• Enabled—The software RAID controller is available.  
USB Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Legacy USB Support  
Whether the system supports legacy USB devices. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—USB devices are only available to EFI applications.  
• Enabled—Legacy USB support is always available.  
• Auto—Disables legacy USB support if no USB devices are  
connected.  
Port 60/64 Emulation  
Whether the system supports 60h/64h emulation for complete USB  
keyboard legacy support. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—60h/64 emulation is not supported.  
• Enabled—60h/64 emulation is supported.  
You should select this option if you are using a non-USB aware  
operating system on the server.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
194  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Name  
Description  
All USB Devices  
Whether all physical and virtual USB devices are enabled or disabled.  
This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—All USB devices are disabled.  
• Enabled—All USB devices are enabled.  
USB Port: Rear  
USB Port: Front  
USB Port: Internal  
USB Port: KVM  
USB Port: VMedia  
Whether the rear panel USB devices are enabled or disabled. This can  
be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Disables the rear panel USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are not detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
• Enabled—Enables the rear panel USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
Whether the front panel USB devices are enabled or disabled. This can  
be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Disables the front panel USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are not detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
• Enabled—Enables the front panel USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
Whether the internal USB devices are enabled or disabled. This can be  
one of the following:  
• Disabled—Disables the internal USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are not detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
• Enabled—Enables the internal USB ports. Devices connected to  
these ports are detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
Whether the KVM ports are enabled or disabled.This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—Disables the KVM port. Devices connected to these  
ports are not detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
• Enabled—Enables the KVM ports. Devices connected to these  
ports are detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
Whether the virtual media devices are enabled or disabled. This can be  
one of the following:  
• Disabled—Disables the vMedia devices.  
• Enabled—Enables the vMedia devices.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
PCI Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
MMIO Above 4GB  
Whether to enable or disable memory mapped I/O of 64-bit PCI  
devices to 4GB or greater address space. Legacy option ROMs  
are not able to access addresses above 4GB. PCI devices that  
are 64-bit compliant but use a legacy option ROM may not  
function correctly with this setting enabled. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The server does not map I/O of 64-bit PCI  
devices to 4GB or greater address space.  
• Enabled—The server maps I/O of 64-bit PCI devices to  
4GB or greater address space.  
ASPM Support  
Allows you to set the level of ASPM (Active Power State  
Management) support in the BIOS.This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—ASPM support is disabled in the BIOS.  
• Force L0s—Force all links to L0 standby (L0s) state.  
• Auto—The CPU determines the power state.  
VGA Priority  
Allows you to set the priority for VGA graphics devices if  
multiple VGA devices are found in the system. This can be one  
of the following:  
• Onboard—Priority is given to the onboard VGA device.  
BIOS post screen and OS boot are driven through the  
onboard VGA port.  
• Offboard—Priority is given to the PCIE Graphics adapter.  
BIOS post screen and OS boot are driven through the  
external graphics adapter port.  
• —Priority is given to the PCIE Graphics adapter, and the  
onboard VGA device is disabled.  
Note  
The vKVM does not function when the onboard  
VGA is disabled.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
196  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Serial Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Console Redirection  
Allows a serial port to be used for console redirection during POST and  
BIOS booting. After the BIOS has booted and the operating system is  
responsible for the server, console redirection is irrelevant and has no  
effect. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—No console redirection occurs during POST.  
• Enabled—Enables console redirection on serial port A during  
POST.  
Terminal Type  
What type of character formatting is used for console redirection. This  
can be one of the following:  
• PC-ANSI—The PC-ANSI terminal font is used.  
• VT100—A supported vt100 video terminal and its character set  
are used.  
• VT100+—A supported vt100-plus video terminal and its character  
set are used.  
• VT-UTF8—A video terminal with the UTF-8 character set is  
used.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote terminal  
application.  
Bits per second  
What BAUD rate is used for the serial port transmission speed. If you  
disable Console Redirection, this option is not available. This can be  
one of the following:  
• 9600—A 9,600 BAUD rate is used.  
• 19200—A 19,200 BAUD rate is used.  
• 38400—A 38,400 BAUD rate is used.  
• 57600—A 57,600 BAUD rate is used.  
• 115200—A 115,200 BAUD rate is used.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote terminal  
application.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Flow Control  
Whether a handshake protocol is used for flow control. Request to Send  
/ Clear to Send (RTS/CTS) helps to reduce frame collisions that can be  
introduced by a hidden terminal problem. This can be one of the  
following:  
• None—No flow control is used.  
• —RTS/CTS is used for flow control.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote terminal  
application.  
Putty KeyPad  
Allows you to change the action of the PuTTY function keys and the  
top row of the numeric keypad. This can be one of the following:  
• VT100—The function keys generate ESC OP through ESC O[.  
• LINUX—Mimics the Linux virtual console. Function keys F6 to  
F12 behave like the default mode, but F1 to F5 generate ESC [[A  
through ESC [[E.  
• XTERMR6—Function keys F5 to F12 behave like the default  
mode. Function keys F1 to F4 generate ESC OP through ESC  
OS, which are the sequences produced by the top row of the  
keypad on Digital terminals.  
• SCO—The function keys F1 to F12 generate ESC [M through  
ESC [X. The function and shift keys generate ESC [Y through  
ESC [j. The control and function keys generate ESC [k through  
ESC [v. The shift, control and function keys generate ESC [w  
through ESC [{.  
• ESCN—The default mode. The function keys match the general  
behavior of Digital terminals. The function keys generate  
sequences such as ESC [11~ and ESC [12~.  
• VT400—The function keys behave like the default mode. The top  
row of the numeric keypad generates ESC OP through ESC OS.  
Redirection After BIOS POST Whether BIOS console redirection should be active after BIOS POST  
is complete and control given to the OS bootloader. This can be one of  
the following:  
• —BIOS Legacy console redirection is active during the OS boot  
and run time.  
• Bootloader—BIOS Legacy console redirection is disabled before  
giving control to the OS boot loader.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
198  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
LOM and PCIe Slots Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
All Onboard LOM Ports  
Whether all LOM ports are enabled or disabled. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—All LOM ports are disabled.  
• Enabled—All LOM ports are enabled.  
LOM Port n OptionROM  
All PCIe Slots OptionROM  
PCIe Slot:n OptionROM  
Whether Option ROM is available on the LOM port designated by n.  
This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Option ROM is not available on LOM port n.  
• Enabled—Option ROM is available on LOM port n.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for UEFI only.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for legacy only.  
Whether the server can use the PCIe Option ROM expansion slots. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—PCIe Option ROMs are not available.  
• Enabled—PCIe Option ROMs are available.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for UEFI only.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for legacy only.  
Whether PCIe expansion slot n is available to the server. This can be  
one of the following:  
• Disabled—The expansion slot n is not available.  
• Enabled—The expansion slot n is available.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for UEFI only.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for legacy only.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Name  
Description  
PCIe Slot:n Link Speed  
This option allows you to restrict the maximum speed of an adapter  
card installed in PCIe slot n. This can be one of the following:  
• GEN1—2.5GT/s (gigatransfers per second) is the maximum speed  
allowed.  
• GEN2—5GT/s is the maximum speed allowed.  
• GEN3—8GT/s is the maximum speed allowed.  
• Disabled—The maximum speed is not restricted.  
For example, if you have a 3rd generation adapter card in PCIe slot 2  
that you want to run at a maximum of 5GT/s instead of the 8GT/s that  
card supports, set the PCIe Slot 2 Link Speed to GEN2. The system  
then ignores the card's supported maximum speed of 8GT/s and forces  
it to run at a maximum of 5 GT/s.  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Name  
Description  
FRB-2 Timer  
Whether the FRB2 timer is used by CIMC to recover the system  
if it hangs during POST. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The FRB2 timer is not used.  
• Enabled—The FRB2 timer is started during POST and  
used to recover the system if necessary.  
OS Watchdog Timer  
Whether the BIOS programs the watchdog timer with a specified  
timeout value. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The watchdog timer is not used to track how  
long the server takes to boot.  
• Enabled—The watchdog timer tracks how long the server  
takes to boot. If the server does not boot within the length  
of time specified  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
200  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Name  
Description  
OS Watchdog Timer Timeout  
What timeout value the BIOS uses to configure the watchdog  
timer. This can be one of the following:  
• —The watchdog timer expires 5 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 10 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 15 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 20 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
Note  
This option is only applicable if you enable the OS  
Boot Watchdog Timer.  
OS Watchdog Timer Policy  
What action the system takes if the watchdog timer expires.  
This can be one of the following:  
• —The server takes no action if the watchdog timer expires  
during OS boot.  
• —The server is powered off if the watchdog timer expires  
during OS boot.  
• Reset—The server is reset if the watchdog timer expires  
during OS boot.  
Note  
This option is only applicable if you enable the OS  
Boot Watchdog Timer.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C22 and C24 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Boot Order Rules  
How the server changes the boot order list defined through the  
CIMC GUI or CLI when there are no devices of a particular  
device type available or when the user defines a different boot  
order using the server's BIOS Setup Utility.  
The supported device types are:  
• HDD—Hard disk drive  
• FDD—Floppy disk drive  
• CDROM—Bootable CD-ROM or DVD  
• PXE—PXE boot  
• EFI—Extensible Firmware Interface  
The Boot Order Rules option can be one of the following:  
• Strict—When no devices of a particular type are available,  
the system creates a placeholder for that device type in the  
boot order list. When a device of that type becomes  
available, it is added to the boot order in the previously  
defined position.  
If the user defines a boot order through the server's BIOS  
Setup Utility, that boot order is given priority over the  
boot order configured through the CIMC GUI or CLI. All  
device types defined through CIMC that are not present  
in the boot order defined through the BIOS Setup Utility  
are removed from the boot order list.  
• Loose—When no devices of a particular type are available,  
the system removes that device type from the boot order.  
When a device of that type becomes available, the system  
adds it to the end of the boot order list.  
If the boot order is configured through the server's BIOS  
Setup Utility, that boot order is given priority over the  
boot order configured through the CIMC GUI or CLI. All  
device types defined through CIMC that are not present  
in the boot order defined through the BIOS Setup Utility  
are moved to the end of the boot order list.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
202  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
C220 and C240 Servers  
C220 and C240 Servers  
Main BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
TPM Support  
TPM (Trusted Platform Module) is a microchip designed to provide  
basic security-related functions primarily involving encryption keys.  
This option allows you to control the TPM Security Device support for  
the system. It can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The server does not use the TPM.  
• Enabled—The server uses the TPM.  
Note  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Processor Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Intel Hyper-Threading Technology  
Whether the processor uses Intel Hyper-Threading Technology,  
which allows multithreaded software applications to execute  
threads in parallel within each processor. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not permit hyperthreading.  
• Enabled—The processor allows for the parallel execution  
of multiple threads.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Number of Enabled Cores  
Allows you to disable one or more of the physical cores on the  
server. This can be one of the following:  
• All—Enables all physical cores. This also enables Hyper  
Threading on the associated logical processor cores.  
• 1 through n—Specifies the number of physical processor  
cores that can run on the server. Each physical core has  
an associated logical core.  
To disable Hyper Threading and have only one logical  
processor core running on the server, select 1.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Execute Disable  
Classifies memory areas on the server to specify where  
application code can execute. As a result of this classification,  
the processor disables code execution if a malicious worm  
attempts to insert code in the buffer. This setting helps to prevent  
damage, worm propagation, and certain classes of malicious  
buffer overflow attacks. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not classify memory areas.  
• Enabled—The processor classifies memory areas.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Intel VT  
Whether the processor uses Intel Virtualization Technology  
(VT), which allows a platform to run multiple operating systems  
and applications in independent partitions. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not permit virtualization.  
• Enabled—The processor allows multiple operating  
systems in independent partitions.  
Note  
If you change this option, you must power cycle the  
server before the setting takes effect.  
Intel VT-d  
Whether the processor uses Intel Virtualization Technology for  
Directed I/O (VT-d). This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not use virtualization  
technology.  
• Enabled—The processor uses virtualization technology.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
204  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Intel VT-d Coherency Support  
Whether the processor supports Intel VT-d Coherency. This can  
be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not support coherency.  
• Enabled—The processor uses VT-d Coherency as  
required.  
Intel VT-d ATS Support  
Whether the processor supports Intel VT-d Address Translation  
Services (ATS). This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not support ATS.  
• Enabled—The processor uses VT-d ATS as required.  
CPU Performance  
Sets the CPU performance profile for the server. The  
performance profile consists of the following options:  
Data Reuse Optimization  
DCU Streamer Prefetcher  
DCU IP Prefetcher  
•
•
•
•
•
Hardware Prefetcher  
Adjacent Cache-Line Prefetch  
This can be one of the following:  
• Enterprise—Only the DCU IP Prefetcher is enabled. The  
rest of the options are disabled.  
• —All options are enabled.  
• HPC—Data Reuse Optimization is disabled and all other  
options are enabled. This setting is also known as high  
performance computing.  
• Custom—All performance profile options can be  
configured from the BIOS setup on the server. In addition,  
the Hardware Prefetcher and Adjacent Cache-Line Prefetch  
options can be configured in the fields below.  
Hardware Prefetcher  
Whether the processor allows the Intel hardware prefetcher to  
fetch streams of data and instruction from memory into the  
unified second-level cache when necessary. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The hardware prefetcher is not used.  
• Enabled—The processor uses the hardware prefetcher  
when cache issues are detected.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Adjacent Cache Line Prefetcher  
Whether the processor fetches cache lines in even/odd pairs  
instead of fetching just the required line. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The processor only fetches the required line.  
• Enabled— The processor fetches both the required line  
and its paired line.  
DCU Streamer Prefetch  
Whether the processor uses the DCU IP Prefetch mechanism to  
analyze historical cache access patterns and preload the most  
relevant lines in the L1 cache. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not try to anticipate cache  
read requirements and only fetches explicitly requested  
lines.  
• Enabled—The DCU prefetcher analyzes the cache read  
pattern and prefetches the next line in the cache if it  
determines that it may be needed.  
DCU IP Prefetcher  
Whether the processor uses the DCU IP Prefetch mechanism to  
analyze historical cache access patterns and preload the most  
relevant lines in the L1 cache. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not preload any cache data.  
• Enabled—The DCU IP prefetcher preloads the L1 cache  
with the data it determines to be the most relevant.  
Direct Cache Access Support  
Allows processors to increase I/O performance by placing data  
from I/O devices directly into the processor cache. This setting  
helps to reduce cache misses. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Data from I/O devices is not placed directly  
into the processor cache.  
• Enabled—Data from I/O devices is placed directly into  
the processor cache.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
206  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Power Technology  
Enables you to configure the CPU power management settings  
for the following options:  
Enhanced Intel Speedstep Technology  
Intel Turbo Boost Technology  
Processor Power State C6  
•
•
•
Power Technology can be one of the following:  
• Custom—The server uses the individual settings for the  
BIOS parameters mentioned above. You must select this  
option if you want to change any of these BIOS  
parameters.  
• Disabled—The server does not perform any CPU power  
management and any settings for the BIOS parameters  
mentioned above are ignored.  
• —The server determines the best settings for the BIOS  
parameters mentioned above and ignores the individual  
settings for these parameters.  
Enhanced Intel Speedstep Technology Whether the processor uses Enhanced Intel SpeedStep  
Technology, which allows the system to dynamically adjust  
processor voltage and core frequency. This technology can result  
in decreased average power consumption and decreased average  
heat production. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor never dynamically adjusts its  
voltage or frequency.  
• Enabled—The processor utilizes Enhanced Intel  
SpeedStep Technology and enables all supported processor  
sleep states to further conserve power.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Note  
must be set to Custom or the server ignores the setting  
for this parameter.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Intel Turbo Boost Technology  
Whether the processor uses Intel Turbo Boost Technology,  
which allows the processor to automatically increase its  
frequency if it is running below power, temperature, or voltage  
specifications. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not increase its frequency  
automatically.  
• Enabled—The processor utilizes Turbo Boost Technology  
if required.  
Note  
must be set to Custom or the server ignores the setting  
for this parameter.  
Processor Power State C6  
Whether the BIOS sends the C6 report to the operating system.  
When the OS receives the report, it can transition the processor  
into the lower C6 power state to decrease energy usage while  
maintaining optimal processor performance. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not send the C6 report.  
• Enabled—The BIOS sends the C6 report, allowing the  
OS to transition the processor to the C6 low power state.  
Note  
must be set to Custom or the server ignores the setting  
for this parameter.  
Processor Power State C1 Enhanced  
Whether the CPU transitions to its minimum frequency when  
entering the C1 state. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The CPU continues to run at its maximum  
frequency in C1 state.  
• Enabled—The CPU transitions to its minimum frequency.  
This option saves the maximum amount of power in C1  
state.  
Frequency Floor Override  
Whether the CPU is allowed to drop below the maximum  
non-turbo frequency when idle. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled— The CPU can drop below the maximum  
non-turbo frequency when idle. This option decreases  
power consumption but may reduce system performance.  
• Enabled— The CPU cannot drop below the maximum  
non-turbo frequency when idle. This option improves  
system performance but may increase power consumption.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
208  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
P-STATE Coordination  
Allows you to define how BIOS communicates the P-state  
support model to the operating system. There are 3 models as  
defined by the Advanced Configuration and Power Interface  
(ACPI) specification.  
• HW_ALL—The processor hardware is responsible for  
coordinating the P-state among logical processors with  
dependencies (all logical processors in a package).  
• SW_ALL—The OS Power Manager (OSPM) is  
responsible for coordinating the P-state among logical  
processors with dependencies (all logical processors in a  
physical package), and must initiate the transition on all  
of the logical processors.  
• SW_ANY—The OS Power Manager (OSPM) is  
responsible for coordinating the P-state among logical  
processors with dependencies (all logical processors in a  
package), and may initiate the transition on any of the  
logical processors in the domain.  
Note  
must be set to Custom or the server ignores the setting  
for this parameter.  
Energy Performance  
Allows you to determine whether system performance or energy  
efficiency is more important on this server. This can be one of  
the following:  
•
•
•
•
Note  
must be set to Custom or the server ignores the setting  
for this parameter.  
In addition, some operating systems, such as Windows  
2008, ignore this parameter in favor of their own power  
plan.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Memory Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Select Memory RAS  
How the memory reliability, availability, and serviceability  
(RAS) is configured for the server. This can be one of the  
following:  
• —System performance is optimized.  
• Mirroring—System reliability is optimized by using half  
the system memory as backup.  
• Lockstep—If the DIMM pairs in the server have an  
identical type, size, and organization and are populated  
across the SMI channels, you can enable lockstep mode  
to minimize memory access latency and provide better  
performance. This option offers better system performance  
than Mirroring and better reliability than Maximum  
Performance but lower reliability than Mirroring and lower  
system performance than Maximum Performance.  
DRAM Clock Throttling  
Allows you to determine whether memory bandwidth or system  
performance is more important on this server. This can be one  
of the following:  
• Balanced— DRAM clock throttling is reduced, providing  
a balance between performance and power.  
• Performance—DRAM clock throttling is disabled,  
providing increased memory bandwidth at the cost of  
additional power.  
• —DRAM clock throttling is increased to improve energy  
efficiency.  
NUMA  
Whether the BIOS supports NUMA. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not support NUMA.  
• Enabled—The BIOS includes the ACPI tables that are  
required for NUMA-aware operating systems. If you  
enable this option, the system must disable Inter-Socket  
Memory interleaving on some platforms.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
210  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Low Voltage DDR Mode  
Whether the system prioritizes low voltage or high frequency  
memory operations. This can be one of the following:  
• —The system prioritizes low voltage memory operations  
over high frequency memory operations. This mode may  
lower memory frequency in order to keep the voltage low.  
• —The system prioritizes high frequency operations over  
low voltage operations.  
DRAM Refresh rate  
Allows you to set the rate at which the DRAM cells are  
refreshed. This can be one of the following:  
• 1x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 64ms.  
• 2x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 32ms.  
• 3x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 21ms.  
• 4x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 16ms.  
Channel Interleaving  
Whether the CPU divides memory blocks and spreads  
contiguous portions of data across interleaved channels to enable  
simultaneous read operations. This can be one of the following:  
• Auto—The CPU determines what interleaving is done.  
• —Some channel interleaving is used.  
•
•
• —The maximum amount of channel interleaving is used.  
Rank Interleaving  
Whether the CPU interleaves physical ranks of memory so that  
one rank can be accessed while another is being refreshed. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Auto—The CPU determines what interleaving is done.  
• —Some rank interleaving is used.  
•
•
• —The maximum amount of rank interleaving is used.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Patrol Scrub  
Whether the system actively searches for, and corrects, single  
bit memory errors even in unused portions of the memory on  
the server. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The system checks for memory ECC errors  
only when the CPU reads or writes a memory address.  
• Enabled—The system periodically reads and writes  
memory searching for ECC errors. If any errors are found,  
the system attempts to fix them. This option may correct  
single bit errors before they become multi-bit errors, but  
it may adversely affect performance when the patrol scrub  
is running.  
Demand Scrub  
Whether the system corrects single bit memory errors  
encountered when the CPU or I/O makes a demand read. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Disabled— Single bit memory errors are not corrected.  
• Enabled— Single bit memory errors are corrected in  
memory and the corrected data is set in response to the  
demand read.  
Altitude  
The approximate number of meters above sea level at which the  
physical server is installed. This can be one of the following:  
• Auto—The CPU determines the physical elevation.  
• —The server is approximately 300 meters above sea level.  
• —The server is approximately 900 meters above sea level.  
• —The server is approximately 1500 meters above sea  
level.  
• —The server is approximately 3000 meters above sea  
level.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
212  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
QPI Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
QPI Link Frequency  
The Intel QuickPath Interconnect (QPI) link frequency, in gigatransfers  
per second (GT/s). This can be one of the following:  
• Auto—The CPU determines the QPI link frequency.  
•
•
•
Onboard Storage Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Onboard SCU Storage Support Whether the onboard software RAID controller is available to the server.  
This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The software RAID controller is not available.  
• Enabled—The software RAID controller is available.  
USB Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Legacy USB Support  
Whether the system supports legacy USB devices. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—USB devices are only available to EFI applications.  
• Enabled—Legacy USB support is always available.  
• Auto—Disables legacy USB support if no USB devices are  
connected.  
Port 60/64 Emulation  
Whether the system supports 60h/64h emulation for complete USB  
keyboard legacy support. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—60h/64 emulation is not supported.  
• Enabled—60h/64 emulation is supported.  
You should select this option if you are using a non-USB aware  
operating system on the server.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
All USB Devices  
Whether all physical and virtual USB devices are enabled or disabled.  
This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—All USB devices are disabled.  
• Enabled—All USB devices are enabled.  
USB Port: Rear  
USB Port: Front  
USB Port: Internal  
USB Port: KVM  
USB Port: VMedia  
Whether the rear panel USB devices are enabled or disabled. This can  
be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Disables the rear panel USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are not detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
• Enabled—Enables the rear panel USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
Whether the front panel USB devices are enabled or disabled. This can  
be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Disables the front panel USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are not detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
• Enabled—Enables the front panel USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
Whether the internal USB devices are enabled or disabled. This can be  
one of the following:  
• Disabled—Disables the internal USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are not detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
• Enabled—Enables the internal USB ports. Devices connected to  
these ports are detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
Whether the KVM ports are enabled or disabled.This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—Disables the KVM port. Devices connected to these  
ports are not detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
• Enabled—Enables the KVM ports. Devices connected to these  
ports are detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
Whether the virtual media devices are enabled or disabled. This can be  
one of the following:  
• Disabled—Disables the vMedia devices.  
• Enabled—Enables the vMedia devices.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
214  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
USB Port: SD Card  
Whether the SD card drives are enabled or disabled. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—Disables the SD card drives. The SD card drives are  
not detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
• Enabled—Enables the SD card drives.  
PCI Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Memory Mapped I/O Above 4GB  
Whether to enable or disable memory mapped I/O of 64-bit PCI  
devices to 4GB or greater address space. Legacy option ROMs  
are not able to access addresses above 4GB. PCI devices that  
are 64-bit compliant but use a legacy option ROM may not  
function correctly with this setting enabled. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The server does not map I/O of 64-bit PCI  
devices to 4GB or greater address space.  
• Enabled—The server maps I/O of 64-bit PCI devices to  
4GB or greater address space.  
ASPM Support  
Allows you to set the level of ASPM (Active Power State  
Management) support in the BIOS.This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—ASPM support is disabled in the BIOS.  
• Force L0s—Force all links to L0 standby (L0s) state.  
• Auto—The CPU determines the power state.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
VGA Priority  
Allows you to set the priority for VGA graphics devices if  
multiple VGA devices are found in the system. This can be one  
of the following:  
• Onboard—Priority is given to the onboard VGA device.  
BIOS post screen and OS boot are driven through the  
onboard VGA port.  
• Offboard—Priority is given to the PCIE Graphics adapter.  
BIOS post screen and OS boot are driven through the  
external graphics adapter port.  
• —Priority is given to the PCIE Graphics adapter, and the  
onboard VGA device is disabled.  
Note  
The vKVM does not function when the onboard  
VGA is disabled.  
Serial Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Console Redirection  
Allows a serial port to be used for console redirection during POST and  
BIOS booting. After the BIOS has booted and the operating system is  
responsible for the server, console redirection is irrelevant and has no  
effect. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—No console redirection occurs during POST.  
• —Enables console redirection on COM port 0 during POST.  
• —Enables console redirection on COM port 1 during POST.  
Terminal Type  
What type of character formatting is used for console redirection. This  
can be one of the following:  
• PC-ANSI—The PC-ANSI terminal font is used.  
• VT100—A supported vt100 video terminal and its character set  
are used.  
• VT100+—A supported vt100-plus video terminal and its character  
set are used.  
• VT-UTF8—A video terminal with the UTF-8 character set is  
used.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote terminal  
application.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
216  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Bits per second  
What BAUD rate is used for the serial port transmission speed. If you  
disable Console Redirection, this option is not available. This can be  
one of the following:  
• 9600—A 9,600 BAUD rate is used.  
• 19200—A 19,200 BAUD rate is used.  
• 38400—A 38,400 BAUD rate is used.  
• 57600—A 57,600 BAUD rate is used.  
• 115200—A 115,200 BAUD rate is used.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote terminal  
application.  
Flow Control  
Whether a handshake protocol is used for flow control. Request to Send  
/ Clear to Send (RTS/CTS) helps to reduce frame collisions that can be  
introduced by a hidden terminal problem. This can be one of the  
following:  
• None—No flow control is used.  
• —RTS/CTS is used for flow control.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote terminal  
application.  
Putty KeyPad  
Allows you to change the action of the PuTTY function keys and the  
top row of the numeric keypad. This can be one of the following:  
• VT100—The function keys generate ESC OP through ESC O[.  
• LINUX—Mimics the Linux virtual console. Function keys F6 to  
F12 behave like the default mode, but F1 to F5 generate ESC [[A  
through ESC [[E.  
• XTERMR6—Function keys F5 to F12 behave like the default  
mode. Function keys F1 to F4 generate ESC OP through ESC  
OS, which are the sequences produced by the top row of the  
keypad on Digital terminals.  
• SCO—The function keys F1 to F12 generate ESC [M through  
ESC [X. The function and shift keys generate ESC [Y through  
ESC [j. The control and function keys generate ESC [k through  
ESC [v. The shift, control and function keys generate ESC [w  
through ESC [{.  
• ESCN—The default mode. The function keys match the general  
behavior of Digital terminals. The function keys generate  
sequences such as ESC [11~ and ESC [12~.  
• VT400—The function keys behave like the default mode. The top  
row of the numeric keypad generates ESC OP through ESC OS.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Redirection After BIOS POST Whether BIOS console redirection should be active after BIOS POST  
is complete and control given to the OS bootloader. This can be one of  
the following:  
• —BIOS Legacy console redirection is active during the OS boot  
and run time.  
• Bootloader—BIOS Legacy console redirection is disabled before  
giving control to the OS boot loader.  
LOM and PCIe Slots Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
All Onboard LOM Ports  
Whether all LOM ports are enabled or disabled. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—All LOM ports are disabled.  
• Enabled—All LOM ports are enabled.  
LOM Port n OptionROM  
Whether Option ROM is available on the LOM port designated by n.  
This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The expansion slot n is not available.  
• Enabled—The expansion slot n is available.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for UEFI only.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for legacy only.  
All PCIe Slots OptionROM  
Whether the server can use the PCIe Option ROM expansion slots. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The expansion slot n is not available.  
• Enabled—The expansion slot n is available.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for UEFI only.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for legacy only.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
218  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
PCIe Slot:n OptionROM  
Whether PCIe expansion slot n is available to the server. This can be  
one of the following:  
• Disabled—The expansion slot n is not available.  
• Enabled—The expansion slot n is available.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for UEFI only.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for legacy only.  
PCIe Mezzanine OptionROM  
Whether the PCIe mezzanine slot expansion ROM is available to the  
server. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The expansion slot n is not available.  
• Enabled—The expansion slot n is available.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for UEFI only.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for legacy only.  
PCIe Slot:n Link Speed  
This option allows you to restrict the maximum speed of an adapter  
card installed in PCIe slot n. This can be one of the following:  
• GEN1—2.5GT/s (gigatransfers per second) is the maximum speed  
allowed.  
• GEN2—5GT/s is the maximum speed allowed.  
• GEN3—8GT/s is the maximum speed allowed.  
• Disabled—The maximum speed is not restricted.  
For example, if you have a 3rd generation adapter card in PCIe slot 2  
that you want to run at a maximum of 5GT/s instead of the 8GT/s that  
card supports, set the PCIe Slot 2 Link Speed to GEN2. The system  
then ignores the card's supported maximum speed of 8GT/s and forces  
it to run at a maximum of 5 GT/s.  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
FRB-2 Timer  
Whether the FRB2 timer is used by CIMC to recover the system  
if it hangs during POST. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The FRB2 timer is not used.  
• Enabled—The FRB2 timer is started during POST and  
used to recover the system if necessary.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C220 and C240 Servers  
Name  
Description  
OS Watchdog Timer  
Whether the BIOS programs the watchdog timer with a specified  
timeout value. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The watchdog timer is not used to track how  
long the server takes to boot.  
• Enabled—The watchdog timer tracks how long the server  
takes to boot. If the server does not boot within the length  
of time specified  
OS Watchdog Timer Timeout  
What timeout value the BIOS uses to configure the watchdog  
timer. This can be one of the following:  
• —The watchdog timer expires 5 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 10 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 15 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 20 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
Note  
This option is only applicable if you enable the OS  
Boot Watchdog Timer.  
OS Watchdog Timer Policy  
What action the system takes if the watchdog timer expires.  
This can be one of the following:  
• —The server takes no action if the watchdog timer expires  
during OS boot.  
• —The server is powered off if the watchdog timer expires  
during OS boot.  
• Reset—The server is reset if the watchdog timer expires  
during OS boot.  
Note  
This option is only applicable if you enable the OS  
Boot Watchdog Timer.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
220  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Name  
Description  
How the server changes the boot order list defined through the  
CIMC GUI or CLI when there are no devices of a particular  
device type available or when the user defines a different boot  
order using the server's BIOS Setup Utility.  
The supported device types are:  
• HDD—Hard disk drive  
• FDD—Floppy disk drive  
• CDROM—Bootable CD-ROM or DVD  
• PXE—PXE boot  
• EFI—Extensible Firmware Interface  
The Boot Order Rules option can be one of the following:  
• Strict—When no devices of a particular type are available,  
the system creates a placeholder for that device type in the  
boot order list. When a device of that type becomes  
available, it is added to the boot order in the previously  
defined position.  
If the user defines a boot order through the server's BIOS  
Setup Utility, that boot order is given priority over the  
boot order configured through the CIMC GUI or CLI. All  
device types defined through CIMC that are not present  
in the boot order defined through the BIOS Setup Utility  
are removed from the boot order list.  
• Loose—When no devices of a particular type are available,  
the system removes that device type from the boot order.  
When a device of that type becomes available, the system  
adds it to the end of the boot order list.  
If the boot order is configured through the server's BIOS  
Setup Utility, that boot order is given priority over the  
boot order configured through the CIMC GUI or CLI. All  
device types defined through CIMC that are not present  
in the  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
C260 Servers  
C260 Servers  
Main BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
Name  
Description  
POST Error Pause  
What happens when the server encounters a critical error during POST.  
This can be one of the following:  
• Enabled—The BIOS pauses the attempt to boot the server and  
opens the Error Manager when a critical error occurs during POST.  
• Disabled—The BIOS continues to attempt to boot the server.  
Boot Option Retry  
Whether the BIOS retries NON-EFI based boot options without waiting  
for user input. This can be one of the following:  
• Enabled—Continually retries NON-EFI based boot options  
without waiting for user input.  
• Disabled—Waits for user input before retrying NON-EFI based  
boot options.  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
Processor Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Intel Turbo Boost Technology  
Whether the processor uses Intel Turbo Boost Technology,  
which allows the processor to automatically increase its  
frequency if it is running below power, temperature, or voltage  
specifications. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not increase its frequency  
automatically.  
• Enabled—The processor utilizes Turbo Boost Technology  
if required.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
222  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Enhanced Intel Speedstep Technology Whether the processor uses Enhanced Intel SpeedStep  
Technology, which allows the system to dynamically adjust  
processor voltage and core frequency. This technology can result  
in decreased average power consumption and decreased average  
heat production. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor never dynamically adjusts its  
voltage or frequency.  
• Enabled—The processor utilizes Enhanced Intel  
SpeedStep Technology and enables all supported processor  
sleep states to further conserve power.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Intel Hyper-Threading Technology  
Whether the processor uses Intel Hyper-Threading Technology,  
which allows multithreaded software applications to execute  
threads in parallel within each processor. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not permit hyperthreading.  
• Enabled—The processor allows for the parallel execution  
of multiple threads.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Number of Enabled Cores  
Allows you to disable one or more of the physical cores on the  
server. This can be one of the following:  
• All—Enables all physical cores. This also enables Hyper  
Threading on the associated logical processor cores.  
• 1 through n—Specifies the number of physical processor  
cores that can run on the server. Each physical core has  
an associated logical core.  
To disable Hyper Threading and have only one logical  
processor core running on the server, select 1.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Execute Disable  
Classifies memory areas on the server to specify where  
application code can execute. As a result of this classification,  
the processor disables code execution if a malicious worm  
attempts to insert code in the buffer. This setting helps to prevent  
damage, worm propagation, and certain classes of malicious  
buffer overflow attacks. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not classify memory areas.  
• Enabled—The processor classifies memory areas.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Intel Virtualization Technology  
Whether the processor uses Intel Virtualization Technology  
(VT), which allows a platform to run multiple operating systems  
and applications in independent partitions. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not permit virtualization.  
• Enabled—The processor allows multiple operating  
systems in independent partitions.  
Note  
If you change this option, you must power cycle the  
server before the setting takes effect.  
Intel VT for Directed IO  
Whether the processor uses Intel Virtualization Technology for  
Directed I/O (VT-d). This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not use virtualization  
technology.  
• Enabled—The processor uses virtualization technology.  
Intel VT-d Interrupt Remapping  
Whether the processor supports Intel VT-d Interrupt Remapping.  
This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not support remapping.  
• Enabled—The processor uses VT-d Interrupt Remapping  
as required.  
Intel VT-d Coherency Support  
Whether the processor supports Intel VT-d Coherency. This can  
be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not support coherency.  
• Enabled—The processor uses VT-d Coherency as  
required.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
224  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Intel VT-d Address Translation Services Whether the processor supports Intel VT-d Address Translation  
Services (ATS). This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not support ATS.  
• Enabled—The processor uses VT-d ATS as required.  
Intel VT-d PassThrough DMA  
Whether the processor supports Intel VT-d Pass-through DMA.  
This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not support pass-through  
DMA.  
• Enabled—The processor uses VT-d Pass-through DMA  
as required.  
Direct Cache Access  
Allows processors to increase I/O performance by placing data  
from I/O devices directly into the processor cache. This setting  
helps to reduce cache misses. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Data from I/O devices is not placed directly  
into the processor cache.  
• Enabled—Data from I/O devices is placed directly into  
the processor cache.  
Processor C3 Report  
Whether the BIOS sends the C3 report to the operating system.  
When the OS receives the report, it can transition the processor  
into the lower C3 power state to decrease energy usage while  
maintaining optimal processor performance. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not send the C3 report.  
• —The BIOS sends the C3 report using the ACPI C2  
format, allowing the OS to transition the processor to the  
C3 low power state.  
• —The BIOS sends the C3 report using the ACPI C3  
format, allowing the OS to transition the processor to the  
C3 low power state.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Processor C6 Report  
Whether the BIOS sends the C6 report to the operating system.  
When the OS receives the report, it can transition the processor  
into the lower C6 power state to decrease energy usage while  
maintaining optimal processor performance. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not send the C6 report.  
• Enabled—The BIOS sends the C6 report, allowing the  
OS to transition the processor to the C6 low power state.  
Package C State Limit  
The amount of power available to the server components when  
they are idle. This can be one of the following:  
• —The server provides all server components with full  
power at all times. This option maintains the highest level  
of performance and requires the greatest amount of power.  
• —When the CPU is idle, the system slightly reduces the  
power consumption. This option requires less power than  
C0 and allows the server to return quickly to high  
performance mode.  
• —When the CPU is idle, the system reduces the power  
consumption further than with the C1 option. This requires  
less power than C1 or C0, but it takes the server slightly  
longer to return to high performance mode.  
• —When the CPU is idle, the system reduces the power  
consumption further than with the C3 option. This option  
saves more power than C0, C1, or C3, but there may be  
performance issues until the server returns to full power.  
• —When the CPU is idle, the server makes a minimal  
amount of power available to the components. This option  
saves the maximum amount of power but it also requires  
the longest time for the server to return to high  
performance mode.  
• —The server may enter any available C state.  
Note  
This option is used only if CPU C State is  
enabled.  
CPU C State  
Whether the system can enter a power savings mode during idle  
periods. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The system remains in high performance state  
even when idle.  
• Enabled—The system can reduce power to system  
components such as the DIMMs and CPUs. The amount  
of power reduction is specified .  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
226  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
Name  
Description  
C1E  
Whether the CPU transitions to its minimum frequency when  
entering the C1 state. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The CPU continues to run at its maximum  
frequency in C1 state.  
• Enabled—The CPU transitions to its minimum frequency.  
This option saves the maximum amount of power in C1  
state.  
Note  
This option is used only if is  
enabled.  
Memory Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Select Memory RAS  
How the memory reliability, availability, and serviceability  
(RAS) is configured for the server. This can be one of the  
following:  
• —System performance is optimized.  
• Mirroring—System reliability is optimized by using half  
the system memory as backup.  
• Sparing—The system reserves some memory for use in  
the event a DIMM fails. If that happens, the server takes  
the DIMM offline and replaces it with the reserved  
memory. This option provides less redundancy than  
mirroring, but it leaves more of the memory available for  
programs running on the server.  
NUMA Optimized  
Whether the BIOS supports NUMA. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not support NUMA.  
• Enabled—The BIOS includes the ACPI tables that are  
required for NUMA-aware operating systems. If you  
enable this option, the system must disable Inter-Socket  
Memory interleaving on some platforms.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Sparing Mode  
The sparing mode used by the CIMC. This can be one of the  
following:  
• —The spared memory is allocated at the rank level.  
• DIMM Sparing—The spared memory is allocated at the  
DIMM level.  
Note  
This option is used only if is set to  
Sparing.  
Mirroring Mode  
Mirroring is supported across Integrated Memory Controllers  
(IMCs) where one memory riser is mirrored with another. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Intersocket—Each IMC is mirrored across two sockets.  
• Intrasocket—One IMC is mirrored with another IMC in  
the same socket.  
Note  
This option is used only if is set to  
Mirroring.  
DRAM Refresh rate  
Allows you to set the rate at which the DRAM cells are  
refreshed. This can be one of the following:  
• 1x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 64ms.  
• 2x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 32ms.  
• 3x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 21ms.  
• 4x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 16ms.  
Patrol Scrub  
Whether the system actively searches for, and corrects, single  
bit memory errors even in unused portions of the memory on  
the server. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The system checks for memory ECC errors  
only when the CPU reads or writes a memory address.  
• Enabled—The system periodically reads and writes  
memory searching for ECC errors. If any errors are found,  
the system attempts to fix them. This option may correct  
single bit errors before they become multi-bit errors, but  
it may adversely affect performance when the patrol scrub  
is running.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
228  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Patrol Scrub Interval  
Controls the time interval between each patrol scrub memory  
access. A lower interval scrubs the memory more often but  
requires more memory bandwidth.  
Select a value between 5 and 23. The default value is 8.  
Note  
This option is used only if Patrol Scrub is  
enabled.  
CKE Low Policy  
Controls the DIMM power savings mode policy. This can be  
one of the following:  
• Disabled—DIMMs do not enter power saving mode.  
• Slow—DIMMs can enter power saving mode, but the  
requirements are higher. Therefore, DIMMs enter power  
saving mode less frequently.  
• Fast—DIMMs enter power saving mode as often as  
possible.  
• Auto—The BIOS controls when a DIMM enters power  
saving mode based on the DIMM configuration.  
Serial Port Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Serial A Enable  
Whether serial port A is enabled or disabled. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The serial port is disabled.  
• Enabled—The serial port is enabled.  
USB Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Make Device Non-Bootable  
Whether the server can boot from a USB device. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The server can boot from a USB device.  
• Enabled—The server cannot boot from a USB device.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
PCI Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Memory Mapped I/O Above 4GB  
Whether to enable or disable memory mapped I/O of 64-bit PCI  
devices to 4GB or greater address space. Legacy option ROMs  
are not able to access addresses above 4GB. PCI devices that  
are 64-bit compliant but use a legacy option ROM may not  
function correctly with this setting enabled. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The server does not map I/O of 64-bit PCI  
devices to 4GB or greater address space.  
• Enabled—The server maps I/O of 64-bit PCI devices to  
4GB or greater address space.  
Onboard NIC n ROM  
Whether the system loads the embedded PXE option ROM for  
the onboard NIC designated by n. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—PXE option ROM is not available for NIC n.  
• Enabled—PXE option ROM is available for NIC n.  
PCIe OptionROMs  
Whether the server can use the PCIe Option ROM expansion  
slots. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—PCIe Option ROMs are not available.  
• Enabled—PCIe Option ROMs are available.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for UEFI only.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for legacy only.  
PCIe Slot n ROM  
Whether PCIe expansion slot n is available to the server. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The expansion slot n is not available.  
• Enabled—The expansion slot n is available.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for UEFI only.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for legacy only.  
Onboard Gbit LOM  
Whether Gbit LOM is enabled or disabled on the server. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Gbit LOM is not available.  
• Enabled—10Git LOM is available.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
230  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Onboard 10Gbit LOM  
Whether 10Gbit LOM is enabled or disabled on the server. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—10GBit LOM is not available.  
• Enabled—10GBit LOM is available.  
Sriov  
Whether SR-IOV (Single Root I/O Virtualization) is enabled  
or disabled on the server. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—SR-IOV is disabled.  
• Enabled—SR-IOV is enabled.  
IOH Resource Allocation  
Enables you to distribute 64KB of 16-bit IO resources between  
IOH0 and IOH1 as per system requirement. This can be one of  
the following:  
• IOH0 24k IOH1 40k— Allocates 24KB of 16-bit IO  
resources to IOH0 and 40KB of 16-bit IO resources to  
IOH1.  
• IOH0 32k IOH1 32k— Allocates 32KB of 16-bit IO  
resources to IOH0 and 32KB of 16-bit IO resources to  
IOH1.  
• IOH0 40k IOH1 24k— Allocates 40KB of 16-bit IO  
resources to IOH0 and 24KB of 16-bit IO resources to  
IOH1.  
• IOH0 48k IOH1 16k— Allocates 48KB of 16-bit IO  
resources to IOH0 and 16KB of 16-bit IO resources to  
IOH1.  
• IOH0 56k IOH1 8k— Allocates 56KB of 16-bit IO  
resources to IOH0 and 8KB of 16-bit IO resources to  
IOH1.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Assert NMI on SERR  
Whether the BIOS generates a non-maskable interrupt (NMI)  
and logs an error when a system error (SERR) occurs. This can  
be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not generate an NMI or log an  
error when a SERR occurs.  
• Enabled—The BIOS generates an NMI and logs an error  
when a SERR occurs. You must enable this setting if you  
want to enable .  
Assert NMI on PERR  
Whether the BIOS generates a non-maskable interrupt (NMI)  
and logs an error when a processor bus parity error (PERR)  
occurs. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not generate an NMI or log an  
error when a PERR occurs.  
• Enabled—The BIOS generates an NMI and logs an error  
when a PERR occurs. You must enable to use this setting.  
Console Redirection  
Allows a serial port to be used for console redirection during  
POST and BIOS booting. After the BIOS has booted and the  
operating system is responsible for the server, console redirection  
is irrelevant and has no effect. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—No console redirection occurs during POST.  
• —Enables console redirection on serial port A during  
POST.  
Note  
If you enable this option, you also disable the display  
of the Quiet Boot logo screen during POST.  
Flow Control  
Whether a handshake protocol is used for flow control. Request  
to Send / Clear to Send (RTS/CTS) helps to reduce frame  
collisions that can be introduced by a hidden terminal problem.  
This can be one of the following:  
• None—No flow control is used.  
• RTS-CTS—RTS/CTS is used for flow control.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote  
terminal application.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
232  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Baud Rate  
What BAUD rate is used for the serial port transmission speed.  
If you disable Console Redirection, this option is not available.  
This can be one of the following:  
• 9.6k—A 9600 BAUD rate is used.  
• 19.2k—A 19200 BAUD rate is used.  
• 38.4k—A 38400 BAUD rate is used.  
• 57.6k—A 57600 BAUD rate is used.  
• 115.2k—A 115200 BAUD rate is used.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote  
terminal application.  
Terminal Type  
What type of character formatting is used for console redirection.  
This can be one of the following:  
• PC-ANSI—The PC-ANSI terminal font is used.  
• VT100—A supported vt100 video terminal and its  
character set are used.  
• VT100-PLUS—A supported vt100-plus video terminal  
and its character set are used.  
• VT-UTF8—A video terminal with the UTF-8 character  
set is used.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote  
terminal application.  
OS Boot Watchdog Timer Timeout  
What timeout value the BIOS uses to configure the watchdog  
timer. This can be one of the following:  
• —The watchdog timer expires 5 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 10 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 15 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 20 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
Note  
This option is only applicable if you enable the OS  
Boot Watchdog Timer.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C260 Servers  
Name  
Description  
OS Boot Watchdog Policy  
What action the system takes if the watchdog timer expires.  
This can be one of the following:  
• —The server is powered off if the watchdog timer expires  
during OS boot.  
• Reset—The server is reset if the watchdog timer expires  
during OS boot.  
Note  
This option is only applicable if you enable the OS  
Boot Watchdog Timer.  
Legacy OS Redirection  
Whether redirection from a legacy operating system, such as  
DOS, is enabled on the serial port. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The serial port enabled for console redirection  
is hidden from the legacy operating system.  
• Enabled—The serial port enabled for console redirection  
is visible to the legacy operating system.  
OS Boot Watchdog Timer  
Whether the BIOS programs the watchdog timer with a specified  
timeout value. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The watchdog timer is not used to track how  
long the server takes to boot.  
• Enabled—The watchdog timer tracks how long the server  
takes to boot. If the server does not boot within the length  
of time specified  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
234  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
C420 Servers  
C420 Servers  
Main BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
TPM Support  
TPM (Trusted Platform Module) is a microchip designed to provide  
basic security-related functions primarily involving encryption keys.  
This option allows you to control the TPM Security Device support for  
the system. It can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The server does not use the TPM.  
• Enabled—The server uses the TPM.  
Note  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Processor Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Intel Hyper-Threading Technology  
Whether the processor uses Intel Hyper-Threading Technology,  
which allows multithreaded software applications to execute  
threads in parallel within each processor. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not permit hyperthreading.  
• Enabled—The processor allows for the parallel execution  
of multiple threads.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Number of Enabled Cores  
Allows you to disable one or more of the physical cores on the  
server. This can be one of the following:  
• All—Enables all physical cores. This also enables Hyper  
Threading on the associated logical processor cores.  
• 1 through n—Specifies the number of physical processor  
cores that can run on the server. Each physical core has  
an associated logical core.  
To disable Hyper Threading and have only one logical  
processor core running on the server, select 1.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Execute Disable  
Classifies memory areas on the server to specify where  
application code can execute. As a result of this classification,  
the processor disables code execution if a malicious worm  
attempts to insert code in the buffer. This setting helps to prevent  
damage, worm propagation, and certain classes of malicious  
buffer overflow attacks. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not classify memory areas.  
• Enabled—The processor classifies memory areas.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Intel VT  
Whether the processor uses Intel Virtualization Technology  
(VT), which allows a platform to run multiple operating systems  
and applications in independent partitions. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not permit virtualization.  
• Enabled—The processor allows multiple operating  
systems in independent partitions.  
Note  
If you change this option, you must power cycle the  
server before the setting takes effect.  
Intel VT-d  
Whether the processor uses Intel Virtualization Technology for  
Directed I/O (VT-d). This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not use virtualization  
technology.  
• Enabled—The processor uses virtualization technology.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
236  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Intel VT-d Coherency Support  
Whether the processor supports Intel VT-d Coherency. This can  
be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not support coherency.  
• Enabled—The processor uses VT-d Coherency as  
required.  
Intel VT-d ATS Support  
Whether the processor supports Intel VT-d Address Translation  
Services (ATS). This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not support ATS.  
• Enabled—The processor uses VT-d ATS as required.  
CPU Performance  
Sets the CPU performance profile for the server. The  
performance profile consists of the following options:  
Data Reuse Optimization  
DCU Streamer Prefetcher  
DCU IP Prefetcher  
•
•
•
•
•
Hardware Prefetcher  
Adjacent Cache-Line Prefetch  
This can be one of the following:  
• Enterprise—Only the DCU IP Prefetcher is enabled. The  
rest of the options are disabled.  
• —All options are enabled.  
• HPC—Data Reuse Optimization is disabled and all other  
options are enabled. This setting is also known as high  
performance computing.  
• Custom—All performance profile options can be  
configured from the BIOS setup on the server. In addition,  
the Hardware Prefetcher and Adjacent Cache-Line Prefetch  
options can be configured in the fields below.  
Hardware Prefetcher  
Whether the processor allows the Intel hardware prefetcher to  
fetch streams of data and instruction from memory into the  
unified second-level cache when necessary. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The hardware prefetcher is not used.  
• Enabled—The processor uses the hardware prefetcher  
when cache issues are detected.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Adjacent Cache Line Prefetcher  
Whether the processor fetches cache lines in even/odd pairs  
instead of fetching just the required line. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The processor only fetches the required line.  
• Enabled— The processor fetches both the required line  
and its paired line.  
DCU Streamer Prefetch  
Whether the processor uses the DCU IP Prefetch mechanism to  
analyze historical cache access patterns and preload the most  
relevant lines in the L1 cache. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not try to anticipate cache  
read requirements and only fetches explicitly requested  
lines.  
• Enabled—The DCU prefetcher analyzes the cache read  
pattern and prefetches the next line in the cache if it  
determines that it may be needed.  
DCU IP Prefetcher  
Whether the processor uses the DCU IP Prefetch mechanism to  
analyze historical cache access patterns and preload the most  
relevant lines in the L1 cache. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not preload any cache data.  
• Enabled—The DCU IP prefetcher preloads the L1 cache  
with the data it determines to be the most relevant.  
Direct Cache Access Support  
Allows processors to increase I/O performance by placing data  
from I/O devices directly into the processor cache. This setting  
helps to reduce cache misses. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Data from I/O devices is not placed directly  
into the processor cache.  
• Enabled—Data from I/O devices is placed directly into  
the processor cache.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
238  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Power Technology  
Enables you to configure the CPU power management settings  
for the following options:  
Enhanced Intel Speedstep Technology  
Intel Turbo Boost Technology  
Processor Power State C6  
•
•
•
Power Technology can be one of the following:  
• Custom—The server uses the individual settings for the  
BIOS parameters mentioned above. You must select this  
option if you want to change any of these BIOS  
parameters.  
• Disabled—The server does not perform any CPU power  
management and any settings for the BIOS parameters  
mentioned above are ignored.  
• —The server determines the best settings for the BIOS  
parameters mentioned above and ignores the individual  
settings for these parameters.  
Enhanced Intel Speedstep Technology Whether the processor uses Enhanced Intel SpeedStep  
Technology, which allows the system to dynamically adjust  
processor voltage and core frequency. This technology can result  
in decreased average power consumption and decreased average  
heat production. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor never dynamically adjusts its  
voltage or frequency.  
• Enabled—The processor utilizes Enhanced Intel  
SpeedStep Technology and enables all supported processor  
sleep states to further conserve power.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Note  
must be set to Custom or the server ignores the setting  
for this parameter.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Intel Turbo Boost Technology  
Whether the processor uses Intel Turbo Boost Technology,  
which allows the processor to automatically increase its  
frequency if it is running below power, temperature, or voltage  
specifications. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not increase its frequency  
automatically.  
• Enabled—The processor utilizes Turbo Boost Technology  
if required.  
Note  
must be set to Custom or the server ignores the setting  
for this parameter.  
Processor Power State C6  
Whether the BIOS sends the C6 report to the operating system.  
When the OS receives the report, it can transition the processor  
into the lower C6 power state to decrease energy usage while  
maintaining optimal processor performance. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not send the C6 report.  
• Enabled—The BIOS sends the C6 report, allowing the  
OS to transition the processor to the C6 low power state.  
Note  
must be set to Custom or the server ignores the setting  
for this parameter.  
Processor Power State C1 Enhanced  
Whether the CPU transitions to its minimum frequency when  
entering the C1 state. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The CPU continues to run at its maximum  
frequency in C1 state.  
• Enabled—The CPU transitions to its minimum frequency.  
This option saves the maximum amount of power in C1  
state.  
Frequency Floor Override  
Whether the CPU is allowed to drop below the maximum  
non-turbo frequency when idle. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled— The CPU can drop below the maximum  
non-turbo frequency when idle. This option decreases  
power consumption but may reduce system performance.  
• Enabled— The CPU cannot drop below the maximum  
non-turbo frequency when idle. This option improves  
system performance but may increase power consumption.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
240  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
P-STATE Coordination  
Allows you to define how BIOS communicates the P-state  
support model to the operating system. There are 3 models as  
defined by the Advanced Configuration and Power Interface  
(ACPI) specification.  
• HW_ALL—The processor hardware is responsible for  
coordinating the P-state among logical processors with  
dependencies (all logical processors in a package).  
• SW_ALL—The OS Power Manager (OSPM) is  
responsible for coordinating the P-state among logical  
processors with dependencies (all logical processors in a  
physical package), and must initiate the transition on all  
of the logical processors.  
• SW_ANY—The OS Power Manager (OSPM) is  
responsible for coordinating the P-state among logical  
processors with dependencies (all logical processors in a  
package), and may initiate the transition on any of the  
logical processors in the domain.  
Note  
must be set to Custom or the server ignores the setting  
for this parameter.  
Energy Performance  
Allows you to determine whether system performance or energy  
efficiency is more important on this server. This can be one of  
the following:  
•
•
•
•
Note  
must be set to Custom or the server ignores the setting  
for this parameter.  
In addition, some operating systems, such as Windows  
2008, ignore this parameter in favor of their own power  
plan.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Memory Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Select Memory RAS  
How the memory reliability, availability, and serviceability  
(RAS) is configured for the server. This can be one of the  
following:  
• —System performance is optimized.  
• Mirroring—System reliability is optimized by using half  
the system memory as backup.  
• Lockstep—If the DIMM pairs in the server have an  
identical type, size, and organization and are populated  
across the SMI channels, you can enable lockstep mode  
to minimize memory access latency and provide better  
performance. This option offers better system performance  
than Mirroring and better reliability than Maximum  
Performance but lower reliability than Mirroring and lower  
system performance than Maximum Performance.  
DRAM Clock Throttling  
Allows you to determine whether memory bandwidth or system  
performance is more important on this server. This can be one  
of the following:  
• Balanced— DRAM clock throttling is reduced, providing  
a balance between performance and power.  
• Performance—DRAM clock throttling is disabled,  
providing increased memory bandwidth at the cost of  
additional power.  
• —DRAM clock throttling is increased to improve energy  
efficiency.  
NUMA  
Whether the BIOS supports NUMA. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not support NUMA.  
• Enabled—The BIOS includes the ACPI tables that are  
required for NUMA-aware operating systems. If you  
enable this option, the system must disable Inter-Socket  
Memory interleaving on some platforms.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
242  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Low Voltage DDR Mode  
Whether the system prioritizes low voltage or high frequency  
memory operations. This can be one of the following:  
• —The system prioritizes low voltage memory operations  
over high frequency memory operations. This mode may  
lower memory frequency in order to keep the voltage low.  
• —The system prioritizes high frequency operations over  
low voltage operations.  
DRAM Refresh rate  
Allows you to set the rate at which the DRAM cells are  
refreshed. This can be one of the following:  
• 1x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 64ms.  
• 2x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 32ms.  
• 3x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 21ms.  
• 4x—DRAM cells are refreshed every 16ms.  
Channel Interleaving  
Whether the CPU divides memory blocks and spreads  
contiguous portions of data across interleaved channels to enable  
simultaneous read operations. This can be one of the following:  
• Auto—The CPU determines what interleaving is done.  
• —Some channel interleaving is used.  
•
•
• —The maximum amount of channel interleaving is used.  
Rank Interleaving  
Whether the CPU interleaves physical ranks of memory so that  
one rank can be accessed while another is being refreshed. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Auto—The CPU determines what interleaving is done.  
• —Some rank interleaving is used.  
•
•
• —The maximum amount of rank interleaving is used.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Patrol Scrub  
Whether the system actively searches for, and corrects, single  
bit memory errors even in unused portions of the memory on  
the server. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The system checks for memory ECC errors  
only when the CPU reads or writes a memory address.  
• Enabled—The system periodically reads and writes  
memory searching for ECC errors. If any errors are found,  
the system attempts to fix them. This option may correct  
single bit errors before they become multi-bit errors, but  
it may adversely affect performance when the patrol scrub  
is running.  
Demand Scrub  
Whether the system corrects single bit memory errors  
encountered when the CPU or I/O makes a demand read. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Disabled— Single bit memory errors are not corrected.  
• Enabled— Single bit memory errors are corrected in  
memory and the corrected data is set in response to the  
demand read.  
Altitude  
The approximate number of meters above sea level at which the  
physical server is installed. This can be one of the following:  
• Auto—The CPU determines the physical elevation.  
• —The server is approximately 300 meters above sea level.  
• —The server is approximately 900 meters above sea level.  
• —The server is approximately 1500 meters above sea  
level.  
• —The server is approximately 3000 meters above sea  
level.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
244  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
QPI Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
QPI Link Frequency  
The Intel QuickPath Interconnect (QPI) link frequency, in gigatransfers  
per second (GT/s). This can be one of the following:  
• Auto—The CPU determines the QPI link frequency.  
•
•
•
USB Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Legacy USB Support  
Whether the system supports legacy USB devices. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—USB devices are only available to EFI applications.  
• Enabled—Legacy USB support is always available.  
• Auto—Disables legacy USB support if no USB devices are  
connected.  
All USB Devices  
USB Port: Rear  
Whether all physical and virtual USB devices are enabled or disabled.  
This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—All USB devices are disabled.  
• Enabled—All USB devices are enabled.  
Whether the rear panel USB devices are enabled or disabled. This can  
be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Disables the rear panel USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are not detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
• Enabled—Enables the rear panel USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
USB Port: Front  
Whether the front panel USB devices are enabled or disabled. This can  
be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Disables the front panel USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are not detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
• Enabled—Enables the front panel USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
USB Port: Internal  
Whether the internal USB devices are enabled or disabled. This can be  
one of the following:  
• Disabled—Disables the internal USB ports. Devices connected  
to these ports are not detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
• Enabled—Enables the internal USB ports. Devices connected to  
these ports are detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
USB Port: KVM  
Whether the KVM ports are enabled or disabled.This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—Disables the KVM port. Devices connected to these  
ports are not detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
• Enabled—Enables the KVM ports. Devices connected to these  
ports are detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
USB Port: VMedia  
USB Port: SD Card  
Whether the virtual media devices are enabled or disabled. This can be  
one of the following:  
• Disabled—Disables the vMedia devices.  
• Enabled—Enables the vMedia devices.  
Whether the SD card drives are enabled or disabled. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—Disables the SD card drives. The SD card drives are  
not detected by the BIOS and operating system.  
• Enabled—Enables the SD card drives.  
PCI Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
MMIO Above 4GB  
Whether to enable or disable memory mapped I/O of 64-bit PCI  
devices to 4GB or greater address space. Legacy option ROMs  
are not able to access addresses above 4GB. PCI devices that  
are 64-bit compliant but use a legacy option ROM may not  
function correctly with this setting enabled. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The server does not map I/O of 64-bit PCI  
devices to 4GB or greater address space.  
• Enabled—The server maps I/O of 64-bit PCI devices to  
4GB or greater address space.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
246  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
ASPM Support  
Allows you to set the level of ASPM (Active Power State  
Management) support in the BIOS.This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—ASPM support is disabled in the BIOS.  
• Force L0s—Force all links to L0 standby (L0s) state.  
• Auto—The CPU determines the power state.  
VGA Priority  
Allows you to set the priority for VGA graphics devices if  
multiple VGA devices are found in the system. This can be one  
of the following:  
• Onboard—Priority is given to the onboard VGA device.  
BIOS post screen and OS boot are driven through the  
onboard VGA port.  
• Offboard—Priority is given to the PCIE Graphics adapter.  
BIOS post screen and OS boot are driven through the  
external graphics adapter port.  
• —Priority is given to the PCIE Graphics adapter, and the  
onboard VGA device is disabled.  
Note  
The vKVM does not function when the onboard  
VGA is disabled.  
Serial Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Console Redirection  
Allows a serial port to be used for console redirection during POST and  
BIOS booting. After the BIOS has booted and the operating system is  
responsible for the server, console redirection is irrelevant and has no  
effect. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—No console redirection occurs during POST.  
• Enabled—Enables console redirection on serial port A during  
POST.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Terminal Type  
What type of character formatting is used for console redirection. This  
can be one of the following:  
• PC-ANSI—The PC-ANSI terminal font is used.  
• VT100—A supported vt100 video terminal and its character set  
are used.  
• VT100+—A supported vt100-plus video terminal and its character  
set are used.  
• VT-UTF8—A video terminal with the UTF-8 character set is  
used.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote terminal  
application.  
Bits per second  
What BAUD rate is used for the serial port transmission speed. If you  
disable Console Redirection, this option is not available. This can be  
one of the following:  
• 9600—A 9,600 BAUD rate is used.  
• 19200—A 19,200 BAUD rate is used.  
• 38400—A 38,400 BAUD rate is used.  
• 57600—A 57,600 BAUD rate is used.  
• 115200—A 115,200 BAUD rate is used.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote terminal  
application.  
Flow Control  
Whether a handshake protocol is used for flow control. Request to Send  
/ Clear to Send (RTS/CTS) helps to reduce frame collisions that can be  
introduced by a hidden terminal problem. This can be one of the  
following:  
• None—No flow control is used.  
• —RTS/CTS is used for flow control.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote terminal  
application.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
248  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Putty KeyPad  
Allows you to change the action of the PuTTY function keys and the  
top row of the numeric keypad. This can be one of the following:  
• VT100—The function keys generate ESC OP through ESC O[.  
• LINUX—Mimics the Linux virtual console. Function keys F6 to  
F12 behave like the default mode, but F1 to F5 generate ESC [[A  
through ESC [[E.  
• XTERMR6—Function keys F5 to F12 behave like the default  
mode. Function keys F1 to F4 generate ESC OP through ESC  
OS, which are the sequences produced by the top row of the  
keypad on Digital terminals.  
• SCO—The function keys F1 to F12 generate ESC [M through  
ESC [X. The function and shift keys generate ESC [Y through  
ESC [j. The control and function keys generate ESC [k through  
ESC [v. The shift, control and function keys generate ESC [w  
through ESC [{.  
• ESCN—The default mode. The function keys match the general  
behavior of Digital terminals. The function keys generate  
sequences such as ESC [11~ and ESC [12~.  
• VT400—The function keys behave like the default mode. The top  
row of the numeric keypad generates ESC OP through ESC OS.  
Redirection After BIOS POST Whether BIOS console redirection should be active after BIOS POST  
is complete and control given to the OS bootloader. This can be one of  
the following:  
• —BIOS Legacy console redirection is active during the OS boot  
and run time.  
• Bootloader—BIOS Legacy console redirection is disabled before  
giving control to the OS boot loader.  
LOM and PCIe Slots Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
All Onboard LOM Ports  
Whether all LOM ports are enabled or disabled. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—All LOM ports are disabled.  
• Enabled—All LOM ports are enabled.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
LOM Port n OptionROM  
Whether Option ROM is available on the LOM port designated by n.  
This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Option ROM is not available on LOM port n.  
• Enabled—Option ROM is available on LOM port n.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for UEFI only.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for legacy only.  
All PCIe Slots OptionROM  
PCIe Slot:n OptionROM  
PCIe Slot:n Link Speed  
Whether the server can use the PCIe Option ROM expansion slots. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—PCIe Option ROMs are not available.  
• Enabled—PCIe Option ROMs are available.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for UEFI only.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for legacy only.  
Whether PCIe expansion slot n is available to the server. This can be  
one of the following:  
• Disabled—The expansion slot n is not available.  
• Enabled—The expansion slot n is available.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for UEFI only.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for legacy only.  
This option allows you to restrict the maximum speed of an adapter  
card installed in PCIe slot n. This can be one of the following:  
• GEN1—2.5GT/s (gigatransfers per second) is the maximum speed  
allowed.  
• GEN2—5GT/s is the maximum speed allowed.  
• GEN3—8GT/s is the maximum speed allowed.  
• Disabled—The maximum speed is not restricted.  
For example, if you have a 3rd generation adapter card in PCIe slot 2  
that you want to run at a maximum of 5GT/s instead of the 8GT/s that  
card supports, set the PCIe Slot 2 Link Speed to GEN2. The system  
then ignores the card's supported maximum speed of 8GT/s and forces  
it to run at a maximum of 5 GT/s.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
250  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
FRB-2 Timer  
Whether the FRB2 timer is used by CIMC to recover the system  
if it hangs during POST. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The FRB2 timer is not used.  
• Enabled—The FRB2 timer is started during POST and  
used to recover the system if necessary.  
OS Watchdog Timer  
Whether the BIOS programs the watchdog timer with a specified  
timeout value. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The watchdog timer is not used to track how  
long the server takes to boot.  
• Enabled—The watchdog timer tracks how long the server  
takes to boot. If the server does not boot within the length  
of time specified  
OS Watchdog Timer Timeout  
What timeout value the BIOS uses to configure the watchdog  
timer. This can be one of the following:  
• —The watchdog timer expires 5 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 10 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 15 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 20 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
Note  
This option is only applicable if you enable the OS  
Boot Watchdog Timer.  
OS Watchdog Timer Policy  
What action the system takes if the watchdog timer expires.  
This can be one of the following:  
• —The server takes no action if the watchdog timer expires  
during OS boot.  
• —The server is powered off if the watchdog timer expires  
during OS boot.  
• Reset—The server is reset if the watchdog timer expires  
during OS boot.  
Note  
This option is only applicable if you enable the OS  
Boot Watchdog Timer.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C420 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Boot Order Rules  
How the server changes the boot order list defined through the  
CIMC GUI or CLI when there are no devices of a particular  
device type available or when the user defines a different boot  
order using the server's BIOS Setup Utility.  
The supported device types are:  
• HDD—Hard disk drive  
• FDD—Floppy disk drive  
• CDROM—Bootable CD-ROM or DVD  
• PXE—PXE boot  
• EFI—Extensible Firmware Interface  
The Boot Order Rules option can be one of the following:  
• Strict—When no devices of a particular type are available,  
the system creates a placeholder for that device type in the  
boot order list. When a device of that type becomes  
available, it is added to the boot order in the previously  
defined position.  
If the user defines a boot order through the server's BIOS  
Setup Utility, that boot order is given priority over the  
boot order configured through the CIMC GUI or CLI. All  
device types defined through CIMC that are not present  
in the boot order defined through the BIOS Setup Utility  
are removed from the boot order list.  
• Loose—When no devices of a particular type are available,  
the system removes that device type from the boot order.  
When a device of that type becomes available, the system  
adds it to the end of the boot order list.  
If the boot order is configured through the server's BIOS  
Setup Utility, that boot order is given priority over the  
boot order configured through the CIMC GUI or CLI. All  
device types defined through CIMC that are not present  
in the boot order defined through the BIOS Setup Utility  
are moved to the end of the boot order list.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
252  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
C460 Servers  
C460 Servers  
Main BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Name  
Description  
POST Error Pause  
What happens when the server encounters a critical error during POST.  
This can be one of the following:  
• Enabled—The BIOS pauses the attempt to boot the server and  
opens the Error Manager when a critical error occurs during POST.  
• Disabled—The BIOS continues to attempt to boot the server.  
Boot Option Retry  
Whether the BIOS retries NON-EFI based boot options without waiting  
for user input. This can be one of the following:  
• Enabled—Continually retries NON-EFI based boot options  
without waiting for user input.  
• Disabled—Waits for user input before retrying NON-EFI based  
boot options.  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Processor Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Intel Turbo Boost Technology  
Whether the processor uses Intel Turbo Boost Technology,  
which allows the processor to automatically increase its  
frequency if it is running below power, temperature, or voltage  
specifications. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not increase its frequency  
automatically.  
• Enabled—The processor utilizes Turbo Boost Technology  
if required.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
253  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Enhanced Intel Speedstep Technology Whether the processor uses Enhanced Intel SpeedStep  
Technology, which allows the system to dynamically adjust  
processor voltage and core frequency. This technology can result  
in decreased average power consumption and decreased average  
heat production. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor never dynamically adjusts its  
voltage or frequency.  
• Enabled—The processor utilizes Enhanced Intel  
SpeedStep Technology and enables all supported processor  
sleep states to further conserve power.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Intel Hyper-Threading Technology  
Whether the processor uses Intel Hyper-Threading Technology,  
which allows multithreaded software applications to execute  
threads in parallel within each processor. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not permit hyperthreading.  
• Enabled—The processor allows for the parallel execution  
of multiple threads.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Number of Enabled Cores  
Allows you to disable one or more of the physical cores on the  
server. This can be one of the following:  
• All—Enables all physical cores. This also enables Hyper  
Threading on the associated logical processor cores.  
• 1 through n—Specifies the number of physical processor  
cores that can run on the server. Each physical core has  
an associated logical core.  
To disable Hyper Threading and have only one logical  
processor core running on the server, select 1.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
254  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Execute Disable  
Classifies memory areas on the server to specify where  
application code can execute. As a result of this classification,  
the processor disables code execution if a malicious worm  
attempts to insert code in the buffer. This setting helps to prevent  
damage, worm propagation, and certain classes of malicious  
buffer overflow attacks. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not classify memory areas.  
• Enabled—The processor classifies memory areas.  
We recommend that you contact your operating system vendor  
to make sure the operating system supports this feature.  
Intel Virtualization Technology  
Whether the processor uses Intel Virtualization Technology  
(VT), which allows a platform to run multiple operating systems  
and applications in independent partitions. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not permit virtualization.  
• Enabled—The processor allows multiple operating  
systems in independent partitions.  
Note  
If you change this option, you must power cycle the  
server before the setting takes effect.  
Intel VT for Directed IO  
Whether the processor uses Intel Virtualization Technology for  
Directed I/O (VT-d). This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not use virtualization  
technology.  
• Enabled—The processor uses virtualization technology.  
Intel VT-d Interrupt Remapping  
Whether the processor supports Intel VT-d Interrupt Remapping.  
This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not support remapping.  
• Enabled—The processor uses VT-d Interrupt Remapping  
as required.  
Intel VT-d Coherency Support  
Whether the processor supports Intel VT-d Coherency. This can  
be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not support coherency.  
• Enabled—The processor uses VT-d Coherency as  
required.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Intel VT-d Address Translation Services Whether the processor supports Intel VT-d Address Translation  
Services (ATS). This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not support ATS.  
• Enabled—The processor uses VT-d ATS as required.  
Intel VT-d PassThrough DMA  
Whether the processor supports Intel VT-d Pass-through DMA.  
This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The processor does not support pass-through  
DMA.  
• Enabled—The processor uses VT-d Pass-through DMA  
as required.  
Direct Cache Access  
Allows processors to increase I/O performance by placing data  
from I/O devices directly into the processor cache. This setting  
helps to reduce cache misses. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Data from I/O devices is not placed directly  
into the processor cache.  
• Enabled—Data from I/O devices is placed directly into  
the processor cache.  
Processor C3 Report  
Whether the BIOS sends the C3 report to the operating system.  
When the OS receives the report, it can transition the processor  
into the lower C3 power state to decrease energy usage while  
maintaining optimal processor performance. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not send the C3 report.  
• —The BIOS sends the C3 report using the ACPI C2  
format, allowing the OS to transition the processor to the  
C3 low power state.  
• —The BIOS sends the C3 report using the ACPI C3  
format, allowing the OS to transition the processor to the  
C3 low power state.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
256  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Processor C6 Report  
Whether the BIOS sends the C6 report to the operating system.  
When the OS receives the report, it can transition the processor  
into the lower C6 power state to decrease energy usage while  
maintaining optimal processor performance. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not send the C6 report.  
• Enabled—The BIOS sends the C6 report, allowing the  
OS to transition the processor to the C6 low power state.  
Package C State Limit  
The amount of power available to the server components when  
they are idle. This can be one of the following:  
• —The server provides all server components with full  
power at all times. This option maintains the highest level  
of performance and requires the greatest amount of power.  
• —When the CPU is idle, the system slightly reduces the  
power consumption. This option requires less power than  
C0 and allows the server to return quickly to high  
performance mode.  
• —When the CPU is idle, the system reduces the power  
consumption further than with the C1 option. This requires  
less power than C1 or C0, but it takes the server slightly  
longer to return to high performance mode.  
• —When the CPU is idle, the system reduces the power  
consumption further than with the C3 option. This option  
saves more power than C0, C1, or C3, but there may be  
performance issues until the server returns to full power.  
• —When the CPU is idle, the server makes a minimal  
amount of power available to the components. This option  
saves the maximum amount of power but it also requires  
the longest time for the server to return to high  
performance mode.  
• —The server may enter any available C state.  
Note  
This option is used only if CPU C State is  
enabled.  
CPU C State  
Whether the system can enter a power savings mode during idle  
periods. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The system remains in high performance state  
even when idle.  
• Enabled—The system can reduce power to system  
components such as the DIMMs and CPUs. The amount  
of power reduction is specified .  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Name  
Description  
C1E  
Whether the CPU transitions to its minimum frequency when  
entering the C1 state. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The CPU continues to run at its maximum  
frequency in C1 state.  
• Enabled—The CPU transitions to its minimum frequency.  
This option saves the maximum amount of power in C1  
state.  
Note  
This option is used only if is  
enabled.  
Memory Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Select Memory RAS  
How the memory reliability, availability, and serviceability  
(RAS) is configured for the server. This can be one of the  
following:  
• —System performance is optimized.  
• Mirroring—System reliability is optimized by using half  
the system memory as backup.  
• Sparing—The system reserves some memory for use in  
the event a DIMM fails. If that happens, the server takes  
the DIMM offline and replaces it with the reserved  
memory. This option provides less redundancy than  
mirroring, but it leaves more of the memory available for  
programs running on the server.  
NUMA Optimized  
Whether the BIOS supports NUMA. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not support NUMA.  
• Enabled—The BIOS includes the ACPI tables that are  
required for NUMA-aware operating systems. If you  
enable this option, the system must disable Inter-Socket  
Memory interleaving on some platforms.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
258  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Sparing Mode  
The sparing mode used by the CIMC. This can be one of the  
following:  
• —The spared memory is allocated at the rank level.  
• DIMM Sparing—The spared memory is allocated at the  
DIMM level.  
Note  
This option is used only if is set to  
Sparing.  
Mirroring Mode  
Mirroring is supported across Integrated Memory Controllers  
(IMCs) where one memory riser is mirrored with another. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Intersocket—Each IMC is mirrored across two sockets.  
• Intrasocket—One IMC is mirrored with another IMC in  
the same socket.  
Note  
This option is used only if is set to  
Mirroring.  
Patrol Scrub  
Whether the system actively searches for, and corrects, single  
bit memory errors even in unused portions of the memory on  
the server. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The system checks for memory ECC errors  
only when the CPU reads or writes a memory address.  
• Enabled—The system periodically reads and writes  
memory searching for ECC errors. If any errors are found,  
the system attempts to fix them. This option may correct  
single bit errors before they become multi-bit errors, but  
it may adversely affect performance when the patrol scrub  
is running.  
Patrol Scrub Interval  
Controls the time interval between each patrol scrub memory  
access. A lower interval scrubs the memory more often but  
requires more memory bandwidth.  
Select a value between 5 and 23. The default value is 8.  
Note  
This option is used only if Patrol Scrub is  
enabled.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Name  
Description  
CKE Low Policy  
Controls the DIMM power savings mode policy. This can be  
one of the following:  
• Disabled—DIMMs do not enter power saving mode.  
• Slow—DIMMs can enter power saving mode, but the  
requirements are higher. Therefore, DIMMs enter power  
saving mode less frequently.  
• Fast—DIMMs enter power saving mode as often as  
possible.  
• Auto—The BIOS controls when a DIMM enters power  
saving mode based on the DIMM configuration.  
Serial Port Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Serial A Enable  
Whether serial port A is enabled or disabled. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The serial port is disabled.  
• Enabled—The serial port is enabled.  
USB Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Make Device Non-Bootable  
Whether the server can boot from a USB device. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The server can boot from a USB device.  
• Enabled—The server cannot boot from a USB device.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
260  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
PCI Configuration Parameters  
Name  
Description  
Memory Mapped I/O Above 4GB  
Whether to enable or disable memory mapped I/O of 64-bit PCI  
devices to 4GB or greater address space. Legacy option ROMs  
are not able to access addresses above 4GB. PCI devices that  
are 64-bit compliant but use a legacy option ROM may not  
function correctly with this setting enabled. This can be one of  
the following:  
• Disabled—The server does not map I/O of 64-bit PCI  
devices to 4GB or greater address space.  
• Enabled—The server maps I/O of 64-bit PCI devices to  
4GB or greater address space.  
Onboard NIC n ROM  
Whether the system loads the embedded PXE option ROM for  
the onboard NIC designated by n. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—PXE option ROM is not available for NIC n.  
• Enabled—PXE option ROM is available for NIC n.  
PCIe OptionROMs  
Whether the server can use the PCIe Option ROM expansion  
slots. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—PCIe Option ROMs are not available.  
• Enabled—PCIe Option ROMs are available.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for UEFI only.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for legacy only.  
PCIe Slot n ROM  
Whether PCIe expansion slot n is available to the server. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The expansion slot n is not available.  
• Enabled—The expansion slot n is available.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for UEFI only.  
• —The expansion slot n is available for legacy only.  
Onboard Gbit LOM  
Whether Gbit LOM is enabled or disabled on the server. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—Gbit LOM is not available.  
• Enabled—10Git LOM is available.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
261  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Advanced BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Onboard 10Gbit LOM  
Whether 10Gbit LOM is enabled or disabled on the server. This  
can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—10GBit LOM is not available.  
• Enabled—10GBit LOM is available.  
Sriov  
Whether SR-IOV (Single Root I/O Virtualization) is enabled  
or disabled on the server. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—SR-IOV is disabled.  
• Enabled—SR-IOV is enabled.  
IOH Resource Allocation  
Enables you to distribute 64KB of 16-bit IO resources between  
IOH0 and IOH1 as per system requirement. This can be one of  
the following:  
• IOH0 24k IOH1 40k— Allocates 24KB of 16-bit IO  
resources to IOH0 and 40KB of 16-bit IO resources to  
IOH1.  
• IOH0 32k IOH1 32k— Allocates 32KB of 16-bit IO  
resources to IOH0 and 32KB of 16-bit IO resources to  
IOH1.  
• IOH0 40k IOH1 24k— Allocates 40KB of 16-bit IO  
resources to IOH0 and 24KB of 16-bit IO resources to  
IOH1.  
• IOH0 48k IOH1 16k— Allocates 48KB of 16-bit IO  
resources to IOH0 and 16KB of 16-bit IO resources to  
IOH1.  
• IOH0 56k IOH1 8k— Allocates 56KB of 16-bit IO  
resources to IOH0 and 8KB of 16-bit IO resources to  
IOH1.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
262  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Assert NMI on SERR  
Whether the BIOS generates a non-maskable interrupt (NMI)  
and logs an error when a system error (SERR) occurs. This can  
be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not generate an NMI or log an  
error when a SERR occurs.  
• Enabled—The BIOS generates an NMI and logs an error  
when a SERR occurs. You must enable this setting if you  
want to enable .  
Assert NMI on PERR  
Whether the BIOS generates a non-maskable interrupt (NMI)  
and logs an error when a processor bus parity error (PERR)  
occurs. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The BIOS does not generate an NMI or log an  
error when a PERR occurs.  
• Enabled—The BIOS generates an NMI and logs an error  
when a PERR occurs. You must enable to use this setting.  
Console Redirection  
Allows a serial port to be used for console redirection during  
POST and BIOS booting. After the BIOS has booted and the  
operating system is responsible for the server, console redirection  
is irrelevant and has no effect. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—No console redirection occurs during POST.  
• —Enables console redirection on serial port A during  
POST.  
Note  
If you enable this option, you also disable the display  
of the Quiet Boot logo screen during POST.  
Flow Control  
Whether a handshake protocol is used for flow control. Request  
to Send / Clear to Send (RTS/CTS) helps to reduce frame  
collisions that can be introduced by a hidden terminal problem.  
This can be one of the following:  
• None—No flow control is used.  
• RTS-CTS—RTS/CTS is used for flow control.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote  
terminal application.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
263  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Name  
Description  
Baud Rate  
What BAUD rate is used for the serial port transmission speed.  
If you disable Console Redirection, this option is not available.  
This can be one of the following:  
• 9.6k—A 9600 BAUD rate is used.  
• 19.2k—A 19200 BAUD rate is used.  
• 38.4k—A 38400 BAUD rate is used.  
• 57.6k—A 57600 BAUD rate is used.  
• 115.2k—A 115200 BAUD rate is used.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote  
terminal application.  
Terminal Type  
What type of character formatting is used for console redirection.  
This can be one of the following:  
• PC-ANSI—The PC-ANSI terminal font is used.  
• VT100—A supported vt100 video terminal and its  
character set are used.  
• VT100-PLUS—A supported vt100-plus video terminal  
and its character set are used.  
• VT-UTF8—A video terminal with the UTF-8 character  
set is used.  
Note  
This setting must match the setting on the remote  
terminal application.  
OS Boot Watchdog Timer Timeout  
What timeout value the BIOS uses to configure the watchdog  
timer. This can be one of the following:  
• —The watchdog timer expires 5 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 10 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 15 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
• —The watchdog timer expires 20 minutes after the OS  
begins to boot.  
Note  
This option is only applicable if you enable the OS  
Boot Watchdog Timer.  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
264  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Name  
Description  
OS Boot Watchdog Policy  
What action the system takes if the watchdog timer expires.  
This can be one of the following:  
• —The server is powered off if the watchdog timer expires  
during OS boot.  
• Reset—The server is reset if the watchdog timer expires  
during OS boot.  
Note  
This option is only applicable if you enable the OS  
Boot Watchdog Timer.  
Legacy OS Redirection  
Whether redirection from a legacy operating system, such as  
DOS, is enabled on the serial port. This can be one of the  
following:  
• Disabled—The serial port enabled for console redirection  
is hidden from the legacy operating system.  
• Enabled—The serial port enabled for console redirection  
is visible to the legacy operating system.  
OS Boot Watchdog Timer  
Whether the BIOS programs the watchdog timer with a specified  
timeout value. This can be one of the following:  
• Disabled—The watchdog timer is not used to track how  
long the server takes to boot.  
• Enabled—The watchdog timer tracks how long the server  
takes to boot. If the server does not boot within the length  
of time specified  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BIOS Parameters by Server Model  
Server Management BIOS Parameters for C460 Servers  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
266  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
I N D E X  
BIOS parameters (continued)  
main parameters for C22 and C24 183  
main parameters for C220 and C240 203  
main parameters for C260 222  
main parameters for C420 235  
main parameters for C460 253  
server management parameters for C22 and C24 200  
server management parameters for C220 and C240 219  
server management parameters for C260 232  
server management parameters for C420 251  
server management parameters for C460 263  
BIOS settings 14, 31, 32, 33, 34  
advanced 32  
A
Active Directory 66, 68, 69  
configuring groups 69  
configuring in CIMC 68  
adapter 46, 85, 127, 128, 129, 130, 131  
activating firmware 131  
configuring properties 85  
exporting the configuration 127  
firmware 130  
importing the configuration 128  
installing firmware 130  
network 85  
PCI 46  
resetting 131  
main 31  
restoring defaults 34  
restoring default configuration 129  
viewing properties 85  
adapters 83  
server boot order 14  
server management 33  
BIOS status 30  
overview 83  
viewing 30  
advanced BIOS parameters 184, 203, 222, 235, 253  
C22 and C24 servers 184  
C220 and C240 servers 203  
C260 server 222  
boot order 14, 15, 16  
about 14  
configuring 15  
viewing 16  
C420 servers 235  
C460 server 253  
boot table 94, 95  
creating entry 94  
deleting entry 94, 95  
description 94  
B
backing up 178  
C
CIMC configuration 178  
bios 176  
recovering corrupt 176  
BIOS 158, 162  
C22 and C24 servers 183, 184, 200  
advanced BIOS parameters 184  
main BIOS parameters 183  
installing from remote server 162  
obtaining firmware from Cisco 158  
BIOS parameters 183, 184, 200, 203, 219, 222, 232, 235, 251, 253, 263  
advanced parameters for C22 and C24 184  
advanced parameters for C220 and C240 203  
advanced parameters for C260 222  
advanced parameters for C420 235  
advanced parameters for C460 253  
server management BIOS parameters 200  
C220 and C240 servers 203, 219  
advanced BIOS parameters 203  
main BIOS parameters 203  
server management BIOS parameters 219  
C260 server 222, 232  
advanced BIOS parameters 222  
main BIOS parameters 222  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
IN-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Index  
C260 server (continued)  
server management BIOS parameters 232  
C420 server 235, 251  
main BIOS parameters 235  
server management BIOS parameters 251  
C420 servers 235  
E
enabling KVM 56, 57  
enabling-auto-learn 124  
encrypting virtual media 58  
event filters, platform 149, 150  
about 149  
advanced BIOS parameters 235  
C460 server 253, 263  
configuring 150  
event log, system 170, 171  
clearing 171  
advanced BIOS parameters 253  
main BIOS parameters 253  
server management BIOS parameters 263  
certificate management 147  
uploading a certificate 147  
CIMC 38, 157, 158, 159, 160, 166, 167, 168, 177  
activating firmware 160  
clearing log 167  
viewing 170  
events 149, 150  
platform 149, 150  
disabling alerts 150  
enabling alerts 149  
exporting 178  
CIMC configuration 178  
configuring log threshold 167  
firmware overview 157  
installing firmware from remote server 159  
obtaining firmware from Cisco 158  
resetting to factory defaults 177  
sending log 168  
F
fan sensors 50  
viewing log 166  
viewing properties 38  
fault summary 165  
viewing 165  
CIMC CLI 3  
faults, logs 165  
CIMC overview 2  
clearing foreign configuration 117  
common properties 75  
viewing summary 165  
FEX 109, 110  
description 109  
communication services properties 133, 134, 136  
HTTP properties 133  
viewing properties 110  
FIP mode 85  
IPMI over LAN properties 136  
SSH properties 134  
configuration 178, 179  
enabling 85  
firmware 157, 158, 159, 160  
about 157  
backing up 178  
activating 160  
exporting 178  
importing 179  
CPU properties 38  
create virtual drive 115  
installing from remote server 159  
obtaining from Cisco 158  
Flexible Flash 24, 25, 27, 28, 42  
booting from 27  
Create Virtual Drive 116  
current sensors 52  
configuring properties 25  
description 24  
resetting 28  
viewing properties 42  
floppy disk emulation 58  
D
date 38  
setting 38  
G
delete virtual drive 118  
disabling KVM 56  
disabling-auto-learn 125  
generate NMI 180  
H
hard drive locator LED 14  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
IN-2  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
hot spare 121, 122, 123  
dedicated 121  
making a global hot spare 122, 123  
memory properties 39  
global 122, 123  
HTTP properties 133  
N
network adapter 85  
viewing properties 85  
network mounted vMedia mapping 59  
cifs 59  
I
importing 179  
CIMC configuration 179  
initializing virtual drive 119  
IP blocking 80  
nfs 59  
www 59  
IPMI over LAN 136  
description 136  
IPMI over LAN properties 136  
IPv4 properties 76  
iscsi-boot 107  
network properties 74, 75, 76, 77, 78  
common properties 75  
IPv4 properties 76  
NIC properties 74  
port profile properties 78  
VLAN properties 77  
network security 80  
NIC properties 74  
NIV mode 85  
vNIC 107  
K
enabling 85  
NTP settings 81  
KVM 56, 57  
Nvidia GPU card information 45  
temperature 45  
configuring 57  
disabling 56  
enabling 56, 57  
KVM console 11, 55  
O
OS installation 11, 12  
methods 11  
L
PXE 12  
local users 65  
locator LED 13, 14  
hard drive 14  
P
server 13  
locator-led 126  
bbu 126  
LOM ports 46  
PCI adapter 46  
viewing properties 46  
persistent binding 96, 97, 98  
description 96  
viewing properties 46  
disabling 97  
enabling 97  
rebuilding 98  
platform event filters 149, 150  
about 149  
M
MAC address 46  
configuring 150  
LOM ports 46  
platform events 153  
interpreting traps 153  
Platform events 149, 150  
diabling alerts 150  
enabling alerts 149  
port profile properties 78  
main BIOS parameters 183, 203, 222, 235, 253  
C22 and C24 servers 183  
C220 and C240 servers 203  
C260 server 222  
C420 server 235  
C460 server 253  
making a dedicated hot spare 121  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
IN-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
power cap policy 21  
configuring 21  
power capping policy 21  
about 21  
server management BIOS parameters 200, 219, 232, 251, 263  
C22 and C24 servers 200  
C220 and C240 servers 219  
C260 server 232  
power cycling the server 19  
power restore policy 23  
power statistics 20  
C420 server 251  
C460 server 263  
server NICs 73  
viewing 20  
server overview 1  
power supply properties 40  
power supply sensors 49  
powering off the server 18  
powering on the server 18  
prepare for removal 122  
PXE installation 12  
server software 1  
set as boot drive 120  
shutting down the server 17  
SNMP 137, 139, 140  
configuring properties 137  
configuring SNMPv3 users 140  
configuring trap settings 139  
sending test message 140  
SSH properties 134  
R
start-learn-cycle 125  
storage properties 40, 43, 44  
viewing adapter properties 40  
viewing physical drive properties 43  
viewing virtual drive properties 44  
storage sensors 52  
viewing 52  
syslog 168  
sending CIMC log 168  
system event log 170, 171  
clearing 171  
recovering from a corrupted bios 176  
remote presence 56, 57, 58, 62, 63  
configuring serial over LAN 62  
launching serial over LAN 63  
virtual KVM 56, 57  
virtual media 58  
reset configuration of cards, Cisco FlexFlash Controller 28  
resetting the server 16  
restore BIOS manufacturing custom defaults 34  
retain configuration, FlexFlash Controller 29  
viewing 170  
S
T
self-signed certificate 145  
sensors 49, 50, 51, 52  
current 52  
technical support data 173  
exporting 173  
Telnet 3  
temperature sensors 50  
time 38  
fan 50  
power supply 49  
temperature 50  
voltage 51  
setting 38  
serial over LAN 61, 62, 63  
configuring 62  
launching 63  
server 37  
U
viewing properties 37  
server management 13, 14, 16, 17, 18, 19  
hard drive locator LED 14  
power cycling the server 19  
powering off the server 18  
powering on the server 18  
resetting the server 16  
server boot order 14  
server locator LED 13  
shutting down the server 17  
undo prepare for removal 124  
uploading a server certificate 147  
user management 65, 68, 71  
Active Directory 68  
local users 65  
terminating user sessions 71  
viewing user sessions 71  
user sessions 71  
terminating 71  
viewing 71  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
IN-4  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
vmedia mapping 60  
removing 60  
viewing properties 60  
vNIC 99, 100, 105, 106, 107, 109  
creating 105  
V
vHBA 86, 87, 88, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98  
boot table 94  
creating 92  
creating boot table entry 94  
deleting 93  
deleting 106  
guidelines for managing 99  
iscsi-boot 107  
deleting boot table entry 94, 95  
disabling persistent binding 97  
enabling persistent binding 97  
guidelines for managing 86  
modifying properties 88  
persistent binding 96  
rebuilding persistent binding 98  
viewing properties 87  
viewing storage controller logs 127  
virtual drive 119, 120  
iscsi-boot deletion 109  
modifying properties 100  
viewing properties 99  
vNICs 107  
iSCSI-boot guidelines 107  
voltage sensors 51  
X
initializing 119  
modifying attributes 120  
set as boot drive 120  
virtual KVM 56, 57  
XML API 135  
description 135  
enabling 135  
virtual media 58  
VLAN properties 77  
VM FEX 109, 110  
Y
description 109  
viewing properties 110  
YAML 8  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
OL-28893-01  
IN-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Cisco UCS C-Series Servers Integrated Management Controller CLI Configuration Guide, Release 1.5  
IN-6  
OL-28893-01  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Black Decker Mixer GM100 User Manual
Bostitch Cordless Saw BTE340K User Manual
Briggs Stratton Plumbing Product 073001 User Manual
Canon Copier IR2022 User Manual
Casio Digital Camera QV 5500SX User Manual
Casio Watch MA0604 EB User Manual
CFM Corporation Ventilation Hood PVS 1 User Manual
Chicago Electric Power Hammer 69276 User Manual
Chromalox Electric Heater CAB User Manual
Cisco Systems Network Card VISM User Manual